PRODUCT GUIDE

Add to my manuals
132 Pages

advertisement

PRODUCT GUIDE | Manualzz
PRODUCT
GUIDE
V O L U M E
1 1
Engineered for the eye
CONTENTS
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
8 - 59
Architectural Lighting
60 - 93
LED VIDEO
94 - 123
CONTROL
124 - 187
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
188 - 233
Accessories
234 - 249
Service
250 - 251
Worldwide partners/index
252 - 256
NOTES
257 - 260
3
Introduction
Martin Professional is the world’s leading dynamic lighting
and visual solutions company. For over 25 years, we’ve worked
in partnership with leading designers to deliver high impact
visual solutions for tours, special events, theatres, TV studios,
nightclubs, leisure environments, and architectural and commercial settings across the globe.
Our state-of-the-art luminaires and video displays are of the
highest quality. Add a line of advanced media servers, lighting
controllers and smoke machines and we offer the industry’s
most comprehensive range of visual solutions.
At Martin, we pride ourselves on the level of excellence we
engineer into every product while aiming to reduce operating and maintenance costs. By providing the most efficient
and durable equipment on the market, Martin products
deliver the industry’s best return on investment.
It is our ambition to be the greenest company in our industry.
That’s why we regard environmental regulations as the minimum standards of environmental performance and are leading a new revolution in green LED research, developing the
most powerful and energy-efficient LED light sources on the
market.
This product guide provides an overview of our entire range.
For all the latest details on individual products, contact your
nearest Martin dealer or view the complete range on our website at
www.martin.com
Martin Professional, September 2012
Follow us on:
facebook.com/MartinProfessional
for
Martin Lighting and Video Package
youtube.com/MartinProfessional
twitter.com/martin_global
r
f Totality” Tou
ck
Korn “Path o
n Bullo
: Jaso
igner
g Des
Lightin
linkedin.com/company/martin-professional-as
5
Engineered for the eye
Sophisticated color and brightness calibration technology
is just one way that we ensure Martin products are of the
highest quality and consistency - product after product, year
after year.
Leaders in LED
- setting new standards in LED performance,
power and efficiency
Leaders in innovation
– merging light and video via a broad
portfolio of award-winning products
Leaders in efficiency
- low power consumption, low operating
costs, second-to-none product
durability
7
ENTERTAINMENT
LIGHTING
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
MAC 101
MAC 101 CT
MAC 101 CLD
MAC 101 WRM
MAC 301 Wash
MAC Aura
MAC 350 Entour
MAC 700 Profile
MAC 700 Wash
MAC TW1
MAC Viper Profile
MAC III Profile
MAC III Performance
MAC III AirFX
MAC III Wash
• Stagebar 2
• Atomic 3000 DMX
• Atomic Colors
• Detonator
9
MAC III
Wash™
MAC III
AirFX™
MAC
TW1™
MAC 700
Wash™
Type & Wattage
1500 W short-arc disharge lamp with 1500 W short arc discharge
Lok-it!™ base
lamp with Lok-it!™ base
1200 W tungsten halogen
700 W short arc discharge
CMY
CMY
COLOR
Color Mixing System
CMY
CMY
CTC
Variable CTC
Variable CTC
Variable CTC
Color Wheel
7-position color wheel plus open
7-position color wheel plus open
8-position color wheel plus open
OPTICS
Beam
Soft-edge beam
Fat, tight beam
Soft-edge beam
Dimming
Mechanical dimming
Mechanical dimming
Internal & external electronic dimming Mechanical dimming
plus mechanical dimming
Soft-edge beam
Lens / Lens Options
9-inch Fresnel
9-inch precision fat-beam PC lens,
optional Fresnel lens
Fresnel (included), narrow, and
multi array
Fresnel
Zoom
Motorized zoom
Motorized zoom
Motorized zoom
Motorized zoom
Beam Angles
*
*
14.5° -41° / 97 - 105° (80 V dimmer)
12.5-66°
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
LIGHT SOURCE
Indexing & rotating beamshaper
EFFECTS
Prism / Frost / Iris / Beamshaper
Rotatable internal barndoors, continu- Fade-in/out wash/motorized iris
ously variable opening, motorized iris
Shutter
Instant blackout/open, strobe and
pulse
Strobe effect up to 10 Hz, random
strobe
Strobe effect up to 10 Hz, random
strobe, pulse effect
540°/242°
540°/246°
Electronic ballast with semi-hot (<90 Electronic ballast with semi-hot (<90
sec.) lamp restrike and flicker-free
sec.) lamp restrike and flicker-free
light
light
80 V dimmer for universal operating
voltage
Electronic ballast with hot lamp restrike
and flicker-free light
*
*
14200 lumens
18700 lumens
53.5 kg (118 lb)
55 kg (121.3 lb)
27.4 kg (60.3 Ib)
32 kg (70.4 Ib)
Gobo
Instant blackout/open, strobe and
pulse
Rotating aerial effects
MOVEMENT
Pan & Tilt
540°/268°
540°/268°
ELECTRICAL
Ballast
PHOTOMETRIC DATA
Maximum Total Output
PHYSICAL
Weight
* See product specification on www.martin.com
11
MAC III
Performance™
MAC Viper
Profile™
MAC 350
Entour™
1500 W short arc discharge lamp with
Lok-it!™ base 1500 W short arc discharge lamp with
Lok-it!™ base 1000 W short-arc discharge
lamp with Lok-it™base
Color Mixing
CMY
CMY
CMY
Variable CTC
Variable CTC
Variable CTC
Variable CTC
Color Wheel
7-position color wheel plus open 7-position color wheel plus open 8-position color wheel plus open
8-position color wheel plus open LIGHT SOURCE
Type & Wattage
LED source COLOR
OPTICS
Dimming
Mechanical dimming Mechanical dimming
Mechanical dimming
Electronic dimming
Lens / Lens Options
Profile (broad front lens)
Profile (broad front lens)
140 mm fat-beam PC lens
Profile
Zoom and Focus
Motorized zoom and focus with zoom- Motorized zoom and focus with zoomfocus tracking focus tracking Motorized zoom
Motorized focus
Beam Angles
11.5° - 55°
11.5° - 55°
*
25°
Gobo animation wheel with full
movement / direction control Gobo animation wheel with full
movement / direction control FX wheel animation effects
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
MAC III
Profile™
EFFECTS
Animation System
Automated Framing System
Interleaved system with full blade
crossover, even focus and continuous
frame rotation. 4 individually
controllable blades Gobo
2 x 5 indexable rotating gobos plus
open 5 indexable rotating gobos plus open 4 FX gobos, 5 rotating breakup and 6 indexable rotating gobos plus open
5 rotating aerial effects
Prism / Frost / Iris / Beamshaper
Interchangeable 4-facet rotating and
indexable prism; optional frost filter
Frost filter; optional interchangeable
4-facet rotating and indexable prism
4-facet rotating prism, variable
frost, motorized iris
Shutter
Instant blackout/open,
strobe and pulse
Instant blackout/open,
strobe and pulse
Instant blackout/open,
strobe and pulse
Electronic strobe, pulse and sine wave
effects, instant open and blackout
540°/268°
540°/268° 540°/268°
630°/300° Electronic ballast, fast lamp re-strike
and flicker-free light Electronic ballast, fast lamp re-strike
and flicker-free light Electronic ballast, flicker-free light
Completely flicker-free
33900 lumens 33900 lumens 26000 lumens
8000 lumens 53.5 kg (117.7 lb)
54.9 kg (120.8 lb)
36 kg (79.4 Ib)
16.6 kg (36.5 lb)
MOVEMENT
Pan & Tilt
ELECTRICAL
Ballast
PHOTOMETRIC DATA
Maximum Total Output
540°/257°
PHYSICAL
Weight
* See product specification on www.martin.com
13
MAC Aura™
MAC 301
Wash™
MAC 101™
MAC 101 CT™
MAC 101 WRM™
MAC 101 CLD™
Type & Wattage
LED source
LED source LED source
LED source
LED source
LED source
Beam (RGBW)
+ Aura (RGB)
RGB
Raw and calibrated RGB
Calibrated cold and warm
white LEDs
Warm white LEDs
Cold white LEDs
Variable CTC
COLOR
Color Mixing System
CTC
Variable CTC
Variable CTC Variable CTC
Color Wheel
Color wheel effect
Electronic 7 color + white
color wheel effect Electronic 33 color + white
color wheel effect
Beam
Beam and aura (secondary
lens array illumination)
Punchy beam, great beam
definition
Tight, punchy beam
Tight, punchy beam
Tight, punchy beam
Tight, punchy beam
Dimming
Electronic dimming; four
dimming curve options
Electronic dimming, fade
options
Electronic dimming; four
dimming curve options
Electronic dimming; four
dimming curve options
Electronic dimming; four
dimming curve options
Electronic dimming; four
dimming curve options
Zoom
Motorized zoom
Fast and efficient zoom
1/10 Peak Angle, All Optical
Configurations
11° -58°
13°-35°
13°/17°/52°
13°/17°/52°
13°/17°/52°
Electronic with pulse, burst
and strobe effects
Strobe effect with pulse and Strobe effect with pulse and
random effects
random effects
Strobe effect with pulse and Strobe effect with pulse and Strobe effect with pulse and
random effects
random effects
random effects
540° /232° 430°/300° 540°/240°
540°/240° 540°/240°
540°/240° Completely flicker-free
Completely flicker-free
Completely flicker-free
Completely flicker-free
Completely flicker-free
Completely flicker-free
3850 lumens
3900 lumens 2400 lumens
4400 lumens
3800 lumens
5900 lumens
5.6 kg (12.3 lb)
8.9 kg (19.6 lb)
3.7 kg (8.2 lb)
3.7 kg (8.2 lb)
3.7 kg (8.2 lb)
3.7 kg (8.2 lb)
OPTICS
Lens / Lens Options
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
LIGHT SOURCE
Wide angle diffuser option
13°/17°/52°
EFFECTS
Shutter
MOVEMENT
Pan & Tilt
ELECTRICAL
Ballast
PHOTOMETRIC DATA
Maximum Total
Output
PHYSICAL
Weight
15
MAC 101™
MAC 101™
Specifications
Minimum LED lifetime: 50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*LED Manufacturer ´s figure obtained under manufacturer ´s test conditions
Control and Programming
Construction
Color: Housing: Protection rating:
Black or white
High-impact flame-retardant thermoplastic
IP20
Installation
The MAC 101 is a remarkably small, super light and easy-to-use
LED moving head wash light with an amazingly bright beam
for such a compact luminaire. It features rapid movement and
calibrated colors with a low price tag that allows for revolutionary
set, stage and decorative lighting design.
Features
• Bright and tight beam
(13° field angle)
• 2400 lm output
• Ultra-compact, low weight
design (3.7 kg)
• Rapid movement – the fastest
MAC ever
• Color calibrated
• Variable CTC
• Smooth, electronic dimming
• High efficiency, low power
consumption, long lifetime
Connections
AC power input: AC power throughput:
DMX data in/out:
Neutrik PowerCon
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
Electrical
AC power:
Maximum total power consumption:
Power supply unit:
Standby power:
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
123 W
Auto-ranging electronic switch mode
<25 W
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: EN 60598-2-17, EN 62471, EN 62031, EN 61347-2-13
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 55015, EN 61547
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Accessories
PHYSICAL
241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
304 mm (12.0 in.)
3.7 kg (8.2 lbs.)
Dynamic Effects
Electronic ‘color wheel’ effect: 33 LEE-referenced colors plus white, color wheel rotation effect, random color
Color mixing: RGB
Red: 0 - 100%
Green: 0 - 100%
Blue: 0 - 100%
Color temperature control: Variable 2500 - 10 000 K
Shutter effect: Electronic, with pulse and random effects
Electronic dimming: 0 - 100%, four dimming curve options
Pan:
540°
Tilt:
240°
Adjustable pan/tilt speed
Optics
Light source: Threaded hole for rigging clamp
Indoor use only, must be fastened to surface or structure
Any
Included Items
Note that power cables and Neutrik PowerCon connectors must be ordered separately (see Accessories)
Specifications
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Mounting points:
Location: Orientation: ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Control options: DMX, 3 control modes (RGB raw/calibrated, RGB + CTC enabled/disabled)
Control resolution: 8-bit, with 16-bit control of pan & tilt
DMX channels: 8/12
Setting and addressing: Control panel with backlit graphic display
Protocol: USITT DMX512/1990
Transceiver: RS-485
Fixture software update:
Via DMX with Martin Universal USB/DMX Converter
Cree XP-E high power emitters
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector, 3 m: P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: P/N 05342804
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCB power output connector, cable mount, light grey:
P/N 05342805
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 1.4 m:
P/N 11850099
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 2.25 m:
P/N 11850100
Set of 8 medium-angle diffusers for MAC 101: P/N 91616018
Set of 4 top hats for MAC 101: P/N 91611358
Set of 5 quick-mount surface mounting brackets for MAC 101: P/N 91606017
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Quick trigger clamp: P/N 91602007
Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.):
P/N 91604003
8-unit flightcase for MAC 101: P/N 91515010
Ordering Information
MAC 101 in cardboard box: MAC 101 in 8-unit flightcase MAC 101 white finish, in cardboard box P/N 90231600
P/N 90231610
P/N 90231630
17
MAC 101 CT™
Optics
Light source: Minimum LED lifetime: Cree XP-E high power emitters
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Control and Programming
CTC, individual cold and warm white intensity
Implemented
8-bit, with 16-bit control of pan & tilt
10
Control panel with backlit graphic display
USITT DMX512-A, ANSI/ESTA E1.20 RDM
RS-485
Via DMX with Martin USB Duo DMX Interface
Installation
Mounting points: Location:
Orientation: One M12 threaded hole for rigging clamp
Indoor use only, must be fastened to surface or structure
Any
Connections
AC power input:
AC power throughput: DMX data in/out:
The ultra-compact MAC 101 LED moving head wash is available
in three white light versions that expand its use to applications
where high quality, pure white light is needed.
The MAC 101 CT incorporates both cold and warm LEDs instead
of RGB for a better white light quality and greater output. Color
temperature calibrated to ensure visual consistency across
fixtures, the MAC 101 CT allows for easy changes in color
temperature from crisp cold looks to warm shades, and features
simple intensity control.
Features
• High quality LED white light
• Ideal for highlighting skin
tones, textiles or set pieces
• Variable color temperature
• Tight and punchy beam effects,
long throw
• Multiple field angle options for
a perfect wash
• Incredibly fast and precise
movement
• Less than 125 watt total power
requirement
• Ultra-compact, low weight
design (3.7 kg)
• Power and data daisy-chain
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
304 mm (12.0 in.)
3.7 kg (8.2 lbs.)
Dynamic Effects
Color temperature control: Shutter effect: Electronic dimming: Pan/Tilt: Adjustable pan/tilt speed
Variable 2800 - 6200 K
Electronic, with pulse and random effects
0 - 100%, four dimming curve options
540°/240°
Neutrik PowerCon
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
Electrical
AC power: Maximum total power consumption: Power supply unit: Standby power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
123 W
Auto-ranging electronic switch mode
<25 W
Thermal
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Control options: RDM: Control resolution: DMX channels: Setting and addressing: Protocol: Transceiver: Fixture software update:
Cooling:
Forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise, user-definable levels)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 5° C (41° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10%): 420 BTU/hr.
approvals:
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety:
US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC:
Australia/NZ:
EN 60598-2-17, EN 62471, EN 62031, EN 61347-2-13
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 55015, EN 61547
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Included Items
User manual: P/N 35000246
Accessories
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector, 3 m: P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: P/N 05342804
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCB power output connector, cable mount, light grey:
P/N 05342805
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 1.4 m:
P/N 11850099
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 2.25 m:
P/N 11850100
Set of 8 medium-angle diffusers for MAC 101: P/N 91616018
Set of 4 top hats for MAC 101: P/N 91611358
Set of 5 quick-mount surface mounting brackets for MAC 101: P/N 91606017
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Quick trigger clamp: P/N 91602007
Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 91604003
8-unit flightcase for MAC 101: P/N 91515010
Ordering Information
MAC 101 CT in cardboard box: MAC 101 CT in 8-unit flightcase: P/N 90231620
P/N 90231625
19
MAC 101 CLD™
DMX channels: Setting and addressing: Protocol: Transceiver: Fixture software update: 7
Control panel with backlit graphic display
USITT DMX512-A, ANSI/ESTA E1.20 RDM
RS-485
Via DMX with Martin USB Duo DMX Interface
Construction
Color: Housing: Protection rating: Black or white
High-impact flame-retardant thermoplastic
IP20
Installation
Connections
AC power input: AC power throughput: DMX data in/out: Neutrik PowerCon
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
Electrical
The MAC 101 CLD uses pure cold LEDs for applications where
only higher color temperatures are required and is intensity
controllable.
• Incredibly fast and precise
movement
• Less than 125 watt total power
requirement
• Ultra-compact, low weight
design (3.7 kg)
• Power and data daisy-chain
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: EN 60598-2-17, EN 62471, EN 62031, EN 61347-2-13
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 55015, EN 61547
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
P/N 35000246
Accessories
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
304 mm (12.0 in.)
3.7 kg (8.2 lbs.)
Dynamic Effects
Electronic, with pulse and random effects
0 - 100%, four dimming curve options
540°/ 240°
Optics
Cree XP-E high power emitters
6700 K
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector, 3 m: P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: P/N 05342804
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCB power output connector, cable mount, light grey:
P/N 05342805
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 1.4 m:
P/N 11850099
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 2.25 m:
P/N 11850100
Set of 8 medium-angle diffusers for MAC 101: P/N 91616018
Set of 4 top hats for MAC 101:
P/N 91611358
Set of 5 quick-mount surface mounting brackets for MAC 101: P/N 91606017
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Quick trigger clamp: P/N 91602007
Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 91604003
8-unit flightcase for MAC 101: P/N 91515010
Ordering Information
Control and Programming
Control: RDM: Control resolution: Approvals
User manual: PHYSICAL
Light source: Color temperature: Minimum LED lifetime: Cooling: Forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise, user-definable levels)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 5° C (41° F) Total heat dissipation
(calculated, +/- 10%): 420 BTU/hr.
Included Items
Specifications
Shutter effect: Electronic dimming: Pan/Tilt: Adjustable pan/tilt speed
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
123 W
Auto-ranging electronic switch mode
5 AT (slow blow)
<25 W
Thermal
Features
• High quality LED white light
• Ideal for highlighting skin
tones, textiles or set pieces
• Tight and punchy beam effects,
long throw
• Multiple field angle options for
a perfect wash
AC power: Maximum total power consumption: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Standby power: ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Mounting points: One M12 threaded hole for rigging clamp
Location: Indoor use only, must be fastened to surface or structure
Orientation: Any
Minimum distance to combustible materials: 100 mm (3.9 in.) from head,
no minimum distance from base
Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: 200 mm (7.9 in.)
DMX
Implemented
8-bit, with 16-bit control of pan & tilt
MAC 101 CLD in cardboard box: MAC 101 CLD in 8-unit flightcase: P/N 90231670
P/N 90231660
21
MAC 101 WRM™
Protocol: Transceiver: Fixture software update: USITT DMX512-A, ANSI/ESTA E1.20 RDM
RS-485
Via DMX with Martin USB Duo DMX Interface
Construction
Color: Housing: Protection rating: Black or white
High-impact flame-retardant thermoplastic
IP20
Installation
Connections
AC power input: AC power throughput: DMX data in/out: Neutrik PowerCon
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
Electrical
The MAC 101 WRM uses pure warm LEDs to mimic the warmth
of tungsten halogen and is intensity controllable.
AC power: Maximum total power consumption: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Standby power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
123 W
Auto-ranging electronic switch mode
5 AT (slow blow)
<25 W
Thermal
Features
• High quality LED white light
• Ideal for highlighting skin
tones, textiles or set pieces
• Tight and punchy beam effects,
long throw
• Multiple field angle options for
a perfect wash
• Incredibly fast and precise
movement
• Less than 125 watt total power
requirement
• Ultra-compact, low weight
design (3.7 kg)
• Power and data daisy-chain
Cooling: Forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise, user-definable levels)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 5° C (41° F) Total heat dissipation
(calculated, +/- 10%): 420 BTU/hr.
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: EN 60598-2-17, EN 62471, EN 62031, EN 61347-2-13
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 55015, EN 61547
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Included Items
Specifications
User manual: P/N 35000246
Accessories
PHYSICAL
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector, 3 m: P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: P/N 05342804
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCB power output connector, cable mount, light grey:
P/N 05342805
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 1.4 m:
P/N 11850099
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 2.25 m:
P/N 11850100
Set of 8 medium-angle diffusers for MAC 101: P/N 91616018
Set of 4 top hats for MAC 101:
P/N 91611358
Set of 5 quick-mount surface mounting brackets for MAC 101: P/N 91606017
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Quick trigger clamp:
P/N 91602007
Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 91604003
8-unit flightcase for MAC 101: P/N 91515010
Control and Programming
Ordering Information
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
241 mm (9.5 in.) across yoke
304 mm (12.0 in.)
3.7 kg (8.2 lbs.)
Dynamic Effects
Shutter effect: Electronic dimming: Pan/Tilt: Adjustable pan/tilt speed
Optics
Light source: Color temperature: Minimum LED lifetime: Control: RDM: Control resolution: DMX channels: Setting and addressing: ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Mounting points: One M12 threaded hole for rigging clamp
Location: Indoor use only, must be fastened to surface or structure
Orientation: Any
Minimum distance to combustible materials: 100 mm (3.9 in.) from head,
no minimum distance from base
Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces:
200 mm (7.9 in.)
Electronic, with pulse and random effects
0 - 100%, four dimming curve options
540°/240°
Cree XP-E high power emitters
2800 K
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
DMX
Implemented
8-bit, with 16-bit control of pan & tilt
7
Control panel with backlit graphic display
MAC 101 WRM in cardboard box: MAC 101 WRM in 8-unit flightcase: P/N 90231650
P/N 90231640
23
MAC 301 Wash™
Specifications
Optics
Light source: Red: Green: Blue:
Luxeon Rebel high power emitters
621-637 nm
525-542 nm
445-461 nm
Control and Programming
DMX, stand-alone, master/slave
8- and 16-bit
12/15/16/19
Control panel with backlit graphic display
USITT DMX512/1990
20 scenes
Control panel with backlit graphic display
RS-485
MAC 301 Software Uploader device
Construction
The MAC 301 Wash is an LED moving head wash light with a
powerfully fast zoom and impressive zoom range. It is capable
of producing a wide range of exceptional colors from rich
saturated shades to pastels through the entire zoom range.
Features
• Fast and efficient zoom: 13 - 35°
• Brightest LED moving head in
its class
• Excellent color mixing for
vibrant saturates and subtle
pastels
• Punchy beam with great beam
definition
Specifications
Dynamic Effects
Black
High-impact flame-retardant thermoplastic
IP20
Installation
Mounting points: Orientation: Minimum distance to combustible materials: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Any
100 mm (3.9 in.) from head, no minimum distance from base
Connections
• S
mooth electronic dimming:
0 - 100%
• Electronic strobe with pulse and
random effects
• Compact and low weight
• Quiet
• DMX-512 control
• All the benefits of LED
AC power input: DMX data in/out: 1.6 m (5.2 ft.) cable tail
3-pin and 5-pin locking XLR
Electrical
AC power: Maximum total power consumption: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Standby power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
350 W
Auto-ranging electronic switch mode
6.3 AT (slow blow)
<60 W
Approvals
EU safety: EN 60598-2-17
EU EMC: EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3, EN 61000-6-2, EN 61000-6-4
US safety (US model): UL 1573
Canadian safety (US model): CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 166
Included Items
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Color: Housing: Protection rating: ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Control options: Control resolution: DMX channels: Setting and addressing: Protocol: Stand-alone memory: Stand-alone and master/slave programming: Transceiver: Fixture software update: 200 mm (7.9 in.)
320 mm (12.6 in.)
388 mm (15.3 in.)
8.9 kg (19.6 lbs.) excl. brackets
Shutter effect: Electronic, with pulse and random effects
Electronic dimming: 0 - 100%, two dimming curve options for overall/individual RGB intensity
Color mixing: RGB
Red: 0 - 100%
Green: 0 - 100%
Blue: 0 - 100%
Electronic ‘color wheel’ effect: 7 colors plus white, color wheel rotation effect, snap, blackout or dimmer fade at color changes
Variable CTC
Zoom: 13 - 36°
Pan: 430°
Tilt: 300°
Adjustable pan/tilt and effects speed
Two Omega clamp attachment brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners for MAC 301: P/N 91602015
Accessories
MAC 301 Software Uploader: MAC 301 Diffusion Filter: Quick trigger clamp: Half-coupler clamp: G-clamp: Safety wire, universal, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): Four-unit flightcase for 4 x MAC 301: P/N 90758099
P/N 91611324
P/N 91602007
P/N 91602005
P/N 91602003
P/N 91604003
P/N 91510021
Ordering Information
MAC 301 Wash, US model, in cardboard box: MAC 301 Wash, US model, in 4-unit flightcase: MAC 301 Wash, EU model, in cardboard box: MAC 301 Wash, EU model, in 4-unit flightcase: P/N 90218100
P/N 90218101
P/N 90218000
P/N 90218001
25
MAC Aura™
Specifications
optics
Light source: Minimum LED lifetime: Osram Ostar high-power emitters
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Control and Programming
Independent control of beam (primary output)
and aura (secondary lens array illumination)
Synchronized beam and aura effects
DMX
Implemented
8-bit, with 16-bit control of pan & tilt
19/25
Control panel with backlit graphic display
USITT DMX512-A, ANSI/ESTA E1.20 RDM
Via DMX with Martin USB Duo DMX Interface
Construction
The MAC Aura is the first compact LED moving head wash
light with zoom that offers never-before-seen, eye-candy aura
effects yet also functions as a highly capable single-lens wash
with fully pre-mixed color. A ground-breaking optical system
combines multicolor LEDs with backlight aura color mixing to
produce an all new visual palette that takes the synthetic look
out of LED for truly unique lighting designs.
Features
• Aura eye-candy effects
• Single-lens wash with fully premixed color
• Broad color palette, RGBW
color mixing
• Uniform shades
• Built-in FX engine
• 11 to 58° zoom
• 3850 lm output
• Rapid movement
• Compact, low weight design
(5.6 kg)
• High efficiency, low power
consumption, long lifetime
Specifications
Dynamic Effects
Black or white
High-impact flame-retardant thermoplastic
IP20
Installation
Mounting points: Location: Orientation: One M12 threaded hole for rigging clamp
Indoor use only, must be fastened to surface or structure
Any
Connections
AC power input: AC power throughput: DMX and RDM data in/out: Neutrik PowerCon
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Maximum total power consumption: 260 W
Power supply unit: Auto-ranging electronic switch mode
Typical power consumption, all effects static, zero light output: <15 W
Approvals
EU safety (pending): EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: EN 60598-2-17, EN 62471
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 55015, EN 61547
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Included Items
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Color: Housing: Protection rating: ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Control options: Macro programs selectable via DMX: Control: RDM: Control resolution: DMX channels: Setting and addressing: Protocol: Fixture software update: 302 mm (11.9 in.) across yoke
302 mm (11.9 in.) across yoke
360 mm (14.2 in.), head straight up
5.6 kg (12.3 lbs.) without accessories
Beam color mixing: RGBW
Aura (secondary lens array illumination) color mixing: RGB
Beam color temperature control:
CTO, variable 10 000 - 2500 K
Beam and aura electronic ‘color wheel’ effect: 33 LEE-referenced colors plus white, variable-speed color-wheel rotation effect and random color
Beam and aura independent shutter effects: Electronic, with regular and random pulse,
burst and strobe effects
Pre-programmed effects: Synchronized beam and aura macros
Electronic dimming: Independent beam and aura, four dimming curve options
Pan/Tilt: 540°/ 232°
Pan and tilt speed: Adjustable via onboard control panel and DMX
M12 bolt suitable for use with Martin rigging clamps
Accessories
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector, 3 m: P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: P/N 05342804
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCB power output connector, cable mount, light grey:
P/N 05342805
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 1.4 m:
P/N 11850099
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 2.25 m:
P/N 11850100
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 91604003
6-unit flightcase for MAC Aura: P/N 91515020
Ordering Information
MAC Aura in cardboard box: MAC Aura in 6-unit flightcase: P/N 90232000
P/N 90232010
27
MAC 350 Entour™
Specifications
Control and Programming
Construction
Color: Housing: Protection rating: The MAC 350 Entour is a cutting-edge LED profile fixture with
no peers. It surpasses what has previously been possible in
terms of brightness, efficiency and compactness in a hard-edge
LED fixture.
Features
• 7 extremely efficient high-power
LEDs
• 8000 lm output sufficient to
replace 575 watt HID fixtures
• Crisp and clean projection with
no color artifacts
• 6 rotating and indexable gobos
• 8 interchangeable dichroic
colors with split color effects
and continuous rotation
• Motorized iris
• Motorized focus
• Full electronic dimming and
strobing
• Compact, low weight design
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width (Base): Height: Height: Weight: 377 mm (14.8 in.) including handles
220 mm (8.7 in.)
454 mm (17.9 in.), head horizontal
471 mm (18.5 in.), head straight up
16.6 kg (36.6 lbs.)
Dynamic Effects
Shutter effect: Electronic, with regular and random pulse, burst and strobe effects
Electronic dimming: 0 - 100%, choice of four dimming curves
Color wheel: 
8 interchangeable dichroic filters + open, full and split colors, music trig continuous rotation, random color
Rotating gobo wheel: 
6 interchangeable gobos + open, indexing, continuous gobo rotation & scrolling, shake
Iris: Motorized, with pulse and random effects
Focus: 2 m (6.6 ft.) to infinity
Pan: 630°
Tilt: 300°
Adjustable pan/tilt and effects speed
Optics
Light source: 7 x Luminus CBT-90 (50 W) LEDs
Minimum LED lifetime: 60 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*LED Manufacturer ´s figure obtained under manufacturer ´s test condition
Black
UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite and die-cast aluminum
IP20
Installation
Mounting points: Orientation: Minimum distance to combustible materials: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Any
200 mm (7.9 in.)
0.5 m (1.6 ft.)
Connections
AC power input: DMX data in/out: ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 14/17
Setting and addressing: Control panel with LED display
Macro programs: 10 pan/tilt and 10 effects macros, all with staggered start/chase feature
Macro selection: DMX or onboard control panel
Movement control options: Tracking and vector
Protocol: USITT DMX512/1990
Stand-alone memory: 100 scenes
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: Control panel with LED display
Transceiver: RS-485
Fixture software update: Serial upload via DMX link
16-bit control: Rotating gobo indexing, pan & tilt
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuses: Standby power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch mode
10 AT (slow blow) x 2
Max. 49 W (idle mode, dimmed to zero)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: EN 60598-2-17, EN 62471, EN 62031, EN 61347-2-13
EN 55015, EN 61547, EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA-E598-2-17
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Included Items
Two Omega clamp attachment brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners: Two 10 AT main fuses (installed): P/N 91602001
P/N 05021029
Accessories
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector,
3 m (9.8 ft.): P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector,
cable mount, blue:
P/N 05342804
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Quick trigger clamp: P/N 91602007
T-shaped omega bracket with quarter-turn fasteners: P/N 91602008
Omega bracket: P/N 91602001
Safety wire, universal, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 91604003
Four-unit flightcase for 4 x MAC 350: P/N 91510160
Ordering Information
MAC 350 Entour, black, in cardboard box: P/N 90231400
29
MAC 700 Profile™
Specifications
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
The MAC 700 Profile is a compact, powerful fixture with an
output and optical precision beyond its peers. It combines a full
CMY color mixing system with an 8-position color wheel and a
patented gobo animation system for subtle or dramatic effects.
It also features rotating gobos, fixed gobos, iris, zoom system
and rotating prism.
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
700 W short arc discharge lamp
Total output up to 14700 lumens
CMY color mixing system
8-position color wheel plus
open
Motorized zoom and focus
Mechanical dimming
Gobo animation wheel with full movement / direction control
Specifications
• 6 indexable rotating gobos plus open
• 9 static gobos plus open
• Interchangeable 3-facet rotating prism
• Motorized iris
• Rapid strobe effects (up to 10 Hz)
• Pan and tilt range of 540°/246°
• Variable fan control for quieter operation
• Electronic ballast with hot lamp restrike and flicker free light
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: LAMP
450 mm (17.7 in.)
365 mm (14.4 in.)
636 mm (25.0 in.), head straight up
34.5 kg (76.1 lbs.)
Type: 700 W short arc discharge
Fitted as standard: Osram HTI 700/D4/75
Color temperature: 7500 K
CRI (Color rendering index): >85
Average lifetime: 750 hours
Hot restrike: Yes
Socket: Double-ended SFc 10-4 with key
Ballast: Electronic
Approved alternative lamp(s): Philips MSR Gold 700 SA/2 DE, GE CSR 700 S/DE/72, Sylvania BA 700/2 DE S 7,5
DMX channels: Setting and addressing: 16-bit control: Movement control options: Protocol: Receiver: Firmware update: CONSTRUCTION
Color(s): Housing: Reflector: Protection rating:
23/31
Control panel with LED display
CMY, color wheel, rotating gobos, gobo animation, mechanical dimmer, focus, zoom, pan & tilt
Tracking and vector
USITT DMX512/1990
Opto-isolated RS-485
Serial upload via DMX link
Black
UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP 20
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Color mixing: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
Color wheel:
8 interchangeable dichroic filters (6 colors and 2 CTC) + open,
indexing, continuous rotation, random color
Rotating gobo wheel:
6 interchangeable gobos + open, indexing, cont. gobo rotation & scrolling, shake
Static gobo wheel: 9 interchangeable gobos + open, indexing, cont. rotation, random gobo
Gobo animation: Interchangeable animation wheel, indexing, cont. rotation with variable angle, speed and direction
Prism: Interchangeable 3-facet rotating prism
Iris: 0 - 100%, pulse effects
Mechanical dimmer: 0 - 100%
Shutter: Strobe effect 2 - 10 Hz, pulse effects, instant open and blackout
Focus: 2 m (6.6 ft.) to infinity
Zoom: 16° - 31°, cut-off angles, with diffuser installed
Pan/tilt: 540°/246°
GOBOS
Outside diameter: 27.9 mm (1.1 in.) +0/- 0.3 mm (0.01 in.)
Maximum image diameter: 23 mm (0.9 in.)
Maximum thickness: 1.1 mm (0.04 in.) in static slots, 4 mm (0.2 in.) in rotating slots
Recommended glass: High-temperature Borofloat or better with dichroic or
enhanced aluminum coating
Recommended metal: 0.5 mm (0.02 in.) aluminum
INSTALLATION
Mounting points: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Orientation: Any
ELECTRICAL
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse (100-120 V power): Main fuse (208-240 V power):
100-120/208-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
15 AT (slow blow)
10 AT (slow blow)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: INCLUDED ITEMS
Osram HTI 700/D4/75 lamp (installed):
Radial breakup gobo animation wheel (installed):
5 extra metal gobos and extra spring
10 AT main fuse (installed):
15 AT main fuse (installed):
Two Omega clamp brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners:
EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
UL 1573
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 166
P/N 97010212
P/N 62325048
P/N 05020025
P/N 05020027
P/N 91602001
31
MAC 700 Profile™
MAC 700 Wash™
Specifications
ACCESSORIES
ORDERING INFORMATION
MAC 700 Profile in cardboard box:
MAC 700 Profile in single flightcase:
P/N 90207000
P/N 90207001
The MAC 700 Wash is an exceptionally powerful wash light with
a clean, even, soft-edged beam, a motorized zoom, indexable
beamshaper and rich CMY color mixing.
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Philips MSR Gold 700 SA/2 DE lamp: P/N 97010312
GE CSR700/S/DE/60 lamp: P/N 97010240
Spiral breakup gobo animation wheel: P/N 62325049
Linear breakup gobo animation wheel: P/N 62325050
Coarse tangential gobo animation wheel: P/N 62325051
Cloud breakup gobo animation wheel: P/N 62325094
Elliptical breakup gobo animation wheel: P/N 62325095
Wash filter for MAC 700 Profile: P/N 91614028G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Quick trigger clamp: P/N 91602007
T-shaped omega bracket with quarter-turn fasteners: P/N 91602008
Double flightcase, MAC 550 Profile, MAC 700 Wash, MAC 700 Profile: P/N 91510020
Features
•
•
•
•
700 W short arc discharge lamp
Total output up to 18700 lumens
CMY color mixing system
8-position color wheel plus
open
• Variable CTC
• Motorized zoom
• Mechanical dimming
• Indexing & rotating beam shaper
• Strobe effect 2-10 Hz, random
strobe, pulse effects
• Pan and tilt range of 540°/246°
• Variable fan control for quieter operation
• Electronic ballast with hot lamp restrike and flicker free light
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 450 mm (17.7 in.)
365 mm (14.4 in.)
656 mm (25.8 in.), head straight up
32 kg (70.5 lbs.)
LAMP
Type: 700 W short arc discharge
Fitted as standard: Osram HTI 700/D4/75
Color temperature: 7500 K
CRI (Color rendering index): >85
Average lifetime: 750 hours
Hot restrike: Yes
Socket: Double-ended SFc 10-4 with key
Ballast: Electronic
Approved alternative lamp(s): Philips MSR Gold 700 SA/2 DE, GE CSR 700 S/DE/72, Sylvania BA 700/2 DE S 7,5
33
MAC 700 Wash™
MAC TW1™
Specifications
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
OPTICS
Beam angle: 
Narrow 14.5° - 27°, Standard 20° - 41°, Very wide 97° - 105°, 1/10 peak angles, 80 V lamp
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
DMX channels: Setting and addressing: 16-bit control: Movement control options: Protocol: Receiver:
Firmware update: 16/23
Control panel with LED display
CMY, CTC, color wheel, mechanical dimmer, zoom, pan & tilt
Tracking and vector
USITT DMX512/1990
Opto-isolated RS 485
Serial upload via DMX link
CONSTRUCTION
Color(s): Housing: Reflector: Protection rating: Black
UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP 20
INSTALLATION
Mounting points: Orientation: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Any
ELECTRICAL
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse (100-120 V power): Main fuse (208-240 V power): 100-120/208-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
15 AT (slow blow)
10 AT (slow blow)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
UL 1573
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 166
INCLUDED ITEMS
Osram HTI 700/D4/75 lamp (installed):
10 AT main fuse (installed): 15 AT main fuse: Two Omega brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners:
P/N 97010212
P/N 05020025
P/N 05020027
P/N 91602001
Features
• 1200 W tungsten halogen lamp
• Total output up to 14200 lumens
• CMY color mixing system
• Motorized zoom
• Fresnel (included), narrow, and
multi array
• Internal & external electronic dimming plus mechanical dimming
• Rapid stobe effects (up to 10 Hz)
• Patented very low-noise cooling
• Various front accessories for theatre, television and film applications
• 80 V dimmer for universal
operating voltage
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length:
Width:
Height:
Weight:
Weight:
454 mm (17.9 in.)
362 mm (14.3 in.)
709 mm (27.9 in.), head straight up
26.8 kg (59.1 lbs.), IGBT dimmer model
27.4 kg (60.4 lbs.), 80 V dimmer model
LAMP
ACCESSORIES
Philips MSR Gold 700 SA/2 DE lamp: P/N 97010312
GE CSR700/S/DE/60 lamp: P/N 97010240
Frost filter: P/N 91611263
T-shaped omega bracket with quarter-turn fasteners: P/N 91602008
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
Quick trigger clamp: P/N 91602007
Super Truss 20.5” mounting plate with half-couplers: P/N 91602014
Swing-wing truss mounting plate with half-couplers: P/N 91602010
Double flightcase, MAC 550 Profile, MAC 700 Wash, MAC 700 Profile: P/N 91510020
ORDERING INFORMATION
MAC 700 Wash in cardboard box:
MAC 700 Wash in single flightcase:
The MAC TW1 is a powerful yet silent tungsten wash light
with a clean, even, soft-edged beam, motorized zoom, and
exceptionally rich CMY color mixing. It can be run from the
built-in dimmer or from an external dimmer.
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Color mixing: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
Color wheel: 8 interchangeable filters (5 colors, UV, half minus green, CTC) + open
Color temperature control: 0 - 100%
Mechanical dimmer: 0 - 100%
Shutter: Strobe effect 2 - 10 Hz, random strobe, pulse effects
Beamshaper: 0° - 360° indexable, continuous rotation
Zoom: 12.5° - 66°, 1/10 peak angles
Pan/tilt: 540°/246°
P/N 90207400
P/N 90207401
Type: Approved lamps: Socket: 1200 W tungsten halogen
Philips 1200/115, 1200/230 or 1200/240 FastFit, Philips Hi-Brite 1200/80 FastFit
PGJX-50
Lamp voltage must match internal or external dimmer output voltage
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color mixing: Electronic dimming: Mechanical dimmer: Shutter: Zoom: 
Pan/tilt: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
Multi-voltage IGBT and 80 V internal dimmer options, ‘plug and play’ external dimming
0 - 100%
Strobe effect up to 10 Hz, random strobe
Narrow 14.5° - 27°, Standard 20° - 41°, Very wide 97° - 105°, 1/10 peak angles, 80 V lamp
540°/242°
35
MAC Viper Profile™
Specifications
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
14/20
Control panel with display
CMY, mechanical dimmer, electronic dimmer, zoom, pan & tilt
Tracking and vector
Various available
USITT DMX512-A
Opto-isolated RS-485
Serial upload via DMX link
DIMMING SYSTEM OPTIONS
Internal multi-voltage IGBT dimmer: 0 - 100%, 8- or 16-bit dimming resolution, controlled via DMX
Internal 80 V dimmer: 0 - 100%, 8- or 16-bit dimming resolution, controlled via DMX
External dimmer input: Intelligent lamp power control
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Reflector: Protection rating: Black, Magnesium alloy, UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP 20
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Mounting points: Any
2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
ELECTRICAL
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: ACOUSTIC
Sound power level: 100-120/200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
20 AT (slow blow)
31 dBA (steady state, lamp on, effects static, Ta=20°C (68° F), test conditions ISO 3743-2:1994)
APPROVALS
EU safety:
EU EMC: US safety:
Canadian safety: EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
UL 1573
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
INCLUDED ITEMS
Two Omega brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners:
Four 20 AT main fuses (installed):
P/N 91602001
P/N 05020051
ACCESSORIES
Very wide angle lens kit:
P/N 91610032
Narrow angle lens kit:
P/N 91610033
Front accessory holder:
P/N 91611260
Internal 80 V dimmer:
P/N 91614026
Flightcase (holds 2 fixtures):
P/N 91510019
Philips Hi-Brite 1200/80 FastFit 80 V lamp:
P/N 97000006
Philips 1200/115 FastFit 115 V lamp:
P/N 97000112
Philips 1200/230 FastFit 230 V lamp:
P/N 97000113
Philips 1200/240 FastFit 240 V lamp:
P/N 97000114
Gel frame, top hat, top hat with louver See www.citytheatrical.com
Half-coupler clamp:
P/N 91602005
G-clamp:
P/N 91602003
Omega bracket:
P/N 91602001
T-shaped omega bracket with quarter-turn fasteners:
P/N 91602008
Safety wire, universal, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.):
P/N 91604003
ORDERING INFORMATION
MAC TW1, Multi-voltage, 80 V dimmer in cardboard box:
MAC TW1, Multi-voltage, 80 V dimmer, 2-unit flightcase:
P/N 90202400
P/N 90202401
The MAC Viper Profile is a new breed of high-output profile
luminaire with an exceptional feature set and highly efficient
optical system that outperforms market-leading profiles in
the 1200-watt range. Its 1000-watt HID source is convincingly
brighter than 1200-watt fixtures and the MAC Viper Profile also
outperforms them in terms of speed and compactness. Power
consumption is lower and output is approximately 50% more
efficient.
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
DMX channels: Setting and addressing: 16-bit control: Movement control options: Dimming curve options: Protocol: Receiver: Firmware update: Features
• 26000 lumens: Excellent light
quality with a very flat and
uniform field
• 1:5 zoom: Fast zoom with autolinked focus
• Fat beam front lens: 140 mm
front lens exceeds the size
of any other fixture in this
segment for just the right fat
beam look
• 5 + 5 rotating gobos: All
glass gobos with optimal
focal separation for superior
morphing effects
• FX wheel: Patent-pending FX
wheel provides an additional 4
fixed gobos and 135° animation
effect
• CMY: Vibrant color mixing
with a superior palette of
colors including true reds, rich
ambers, primary green and
deep blues
• 8-slot color wheel: Fixed colors
for added color choice
• Linear CTO: Daylight to
tungsten CCT control and
expansion of the CMY palette
• Dimmer and shutter: Combined
dimmer/shutter system with
intensity effects, instant
blackout/open and smooth
fades
• Iris: Fast and tight iris with
adjustable dynamic effects
• Strobe: Diverse strobe effects
using mechanical or electronic
control or in combination
• Soft frost: A light frost leaves
gobo artwork visible with a
beautiful soft edge. Includes a
linear focus blurring option
• 4-facet prism: Real beam
separation with rotation and
index control for dynamic
effects and accurate tiling
37
MAC Viper Profile™
Specifications
Physical
566 mm (22.3 in.)
472 mm (18.6 in.)
335 mm (13.2 in.)
731 mm (28.8 in.)
748 mm (29.4 in.)
36 kg (79.4 lbs.)
Lamp
Approved lamp: Type: Color temperature: CRI (Color rendering index): Average lifetime: Socket: Ballast: Osram HTI 1000/PS Lok-it
1000 W short-arc discharge
6000 K
>85
750 hours
PGJ28 Lok-it
Electronic
Dynamic Effects
Color mixing: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
Color temperature control: CTO, variable 6000 - 3200 K
Color wheel: 8 interchangeable dichroic filters +
open, indexing, continuous rotation, random color
Aerial wheel: 5 interchangeable aerial effects +
open, indexing, continuous rotation and shake
Breakup wheel: 5 interchangeable texture/breakup gobos +
open, indexing, continuous rotation and shake
FX wheel: Interchangeable static gobo and gobo animation effects
Prism:
Interchangeable 4-facet rotating prism
Iris: 0 - 100%, pulse effects
Frost: Frost filter
Mechanical dimmer/shutter: 0 - 100% continuous dimming, variable & random strobe & pulse effects, instant open & blackout
Dimming options: Choice of four dimming curves
Focus: Range varies with zoom angle, from 2 m (6.6 ft.) / 6 m (19.7 ft.) to infinity (approx.)
Zoom: 10° - 44°
Zoom-focus linking system: 3-zone
Pan: 540°
Tilt: 268°
Position correction system: Absolute position monitoring
Control and Programming
DMX channels: 26/34
Setting and addressing: Control panel with backlit graphic display and jog wheel or via DMX
16-bit control:Aerial, breakup and texture effect rotation and indexing, focus, zoom, pan and tilt
DMX compliance:
USITT DMX512-A
RDM compliance:
ANSI/ESTA E1.20
Receiver: Opto-isolated RS-485
Firmware update: USB memory device or USB/DMX hardware interface over DMX link
Fixture identification: User-settable fixture ID number
Construction
Color(s): Housing: Reflector: Protection rating: Installation
Mounting points: Orientation: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Minimum distance to combustible materials: Black
UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP20
120-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
16.2 A
Typical Power and Current
120 V, 60 Hz:
1225 W, 10.3 A, PF 0.999
208 V, 60 Hz:
1190 W, 5.8 A, PF 0.996
230 V, 50 Hz:
1186 W, 5.2 A, PF 0.994
240 V, 50 Hz:
1194 W, 5.0 A, PF 0.993
Measurements made at nominal voltage. Allow for a deviation of +/- 10%. PF = power factor
Thermal
Cooling: Filtered forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 5° C (41° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C (104° F): 150° C (302° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10% at 120 V, 60 Hz): 4180 BTU/hr
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: EN 60598-2-17 (EN 60598-1), EN 62471
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61547
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CSA E598-2-17 (CSA E60598-1)
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Included Items
Lamp (installed): Two Omega clamp attachment brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners: Safety and installation manual: P/N 97010346
P/N 91602001
P/N 35000258
Accessories
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon
NAC3FCA input connector, 3 m (9.8 ft.): Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector,
cable mount, blue:
Omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners:
T-shaped omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners:
Half-coupler clamp: G-clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only):
Quick-trigger clamp
(suspension with yoke vertically downwards only):
Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.):
Flightcase for 2 x MAC Viper:
P/N 11541503
P/N 05342804
P/N 91602001
P/N 91602008
P/N 91602005
P/N 91602003
P/N 91602007
P/N 91604003
P/N 91510180
Related Items
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface Box: Service Utilities
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
USB host socket
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Length (Head): Width: Width (Base): Height (head straight up): Height (maximum): Weight: Connections
AC power input: DMX and RDM data in/out: USB memory devices: Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Typical half-cycle RMS inrush current: P/N 90703010
Spare Parts
Replacement lamp: Head air filter
P/N 97010346
Ordering Information
MAC Viper Profile in cardboard box: MAC Viper Profile in double flightcase: P/N 90233000
P/N 90233010
Eight quarter-turn locking points
Any
1.6 m (5.2 ft.)
0.3 m (1.0 ft.)
39
MAC III Profile™
Specifications
Physical
Length (Head): Width: Height: Weight: 712 mm
536 mm
936 mm
53.5 kg
Lamp
1500 W short-arc discharge
Osram HTI 1500W/60/P50
6000 K
>85
750 hours
Semi-hot (restrike in under 90 seconds)
PGJ50
Electronic
Dynamic Effects
The MAC III Profile offers a perfect balance between a superior
feature list and ultimate performance. This high-output profile
combines advanced 1500-watt lamp technology with superb
optical efficiency, an innovative design and great feel to take
moving head performance to a higher level.
Features
• 1500 W short arc discharge
lamp with Lok-it!” base
• CMY plus variable CTO with
non-fade coating technology
• 7-position color wheel plus
open
• 2 x 5 indexable rotating gobos
plus open
• 1:5 zoom with focus tracking
• Completely uniform dimming
plus mechanical shutter for
total blackout
• Interchangeable 4-facet
rotating and indexable prism
• Motorized iris
• Mechanical and electronic
strobe effect 2 - 10 Hz, pulse
effects, instant open and
blackout
• Gobo animation wheel with full
movement / direction control
• Pan and tilt (540°/267°) with
absolute positioning control
• Patented very low-noise
cooling. Quietest fixture in
its class
• Modular design for easy
maintenance, servicing and
product conversion
• Electronic ballast, fast lamp
re-strike and flicker free light
• RDM ready, service USB and
Art-Net II prepared
• Battery-powered TFT display
and jog wheel navigation
• Easy conversion between a
profile and performance - no
need to invest in two separate
fixtures
Color mixing: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
Color temperature control: CTO, variable 6000 - 3200 K
Color wheel: 7 interchangeable dichroic filters + open, indexing,
continuous rotation, random color
Rotating gobo wheel: Two rotating gobo wheels, each with 5 interchangeable
rotating gobos + open, gobo indexing, continuous rotation and shake
Gobo animation: Interchangeable animation wheel, indexing,
continuous rotation with variable angle, speed and direction
Prism: Interchangeable 4-facet rotating prism
Iris: 0 - 100%, pulse effects
Mechanical dimmer: 0 - 100%, choice of four dimming curves
Mechanical shutter: Strobe effect 2 - 10 Hz, pulse effects, instant open and blackout
Focus: 2 m to infinity
Zoom: Motorized
Zoom-focus linking system: 3-zone
Pan: 540°
Tilt: 268°
Position correction system: Absolute position monitoring
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Type: Fitted as standard: Color temperature: CRI (Color rendering index): Average lifetime: Hot restrike: Socket: Ballast: Control and Programming
DMX channels:
27/30
Setting and addressing: Control panel with backlit graphic display and jog wheel or via DMX
16-bit control: Dimmer, gobo indexing (gobo wheels 1 and 2), focus, zoom, pan and tilt
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A, RDM
Receiver: Opto-isolated RS-485
Firmware update: USB memory device and remote via DMX link
Construction
Color(s): Housing: Reflector: Protection rating: Black
Magnesium alloy, UV-resistant fibre-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP20
Gobos
Size: Approved material: Outside diameter: Maximum image diameter: Maximum thickness: E
Borosilicate 3.3 or better with dichroic or
heavy matted aluminum coating (metal gobos not approved)
37.5 mm +0/- 0.2 mm
30 mm +/- 0.4 mm
1.1 mm +/- 0.1 mm
Gobo Animation Wheel
Outside diameter: Image outer diameter: Image inner diameter: Thickness: Construction: 133.9 mm (5.3 in.) +/- 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
130 mm (5.1 in.)
32 mm (1.3 in.)
1.1 mm (0.04 in.) +/- 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
Borofloat or better with dichroic or enhanced aluminium coating
41
MAC III Profile™
MAC III Performance™
Specifications
Installation
Mounting points: Orientation: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Minimum distance to combustible materials: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Any
2.5 m (8.2 ft.)
0.2 m (0.7 ft.)
Connections
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuses: 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
16 AT (x 2)
Thermal
Cooling: Filtered forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C: 170° C (338° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10% at 200 V, 60 Hz): 6160 BTU/hr
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
UL 1573
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
Included Items
Osram HTI 1500W/60/P50 lamp (installed):
Tribal waves gobo animation wheel (installed):
Two Omega clamp attachment brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners:
P/N 97010326
P/N 62325143
P/N 91602001
Accessories
3 m power cable, 12 AWG, SJT, with PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector:
P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue:
P/N05342804
Philips MSR Gold 1500 Fastfit lamp
P/N 97010340
Omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners:
P/N 91602001
T-shaped omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners: P/N 91602008
Half-coupler clamp
P/N 91602005
G-clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only):
P/N 91602003
Quick-trigger clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only): P/N 91602007
Swing-wing mounting plate (with half-couplers):
P/N 91602010
Super Truss 20.5" mounting plate with half-couplers
P/N 91602014
Safety wire, SWL 70 kg (154 lb.) P/N 91604004
MAC III Framing Module Kit (converts Profile to Performance) P/N 91614032
Ordering Information
MAC III Profile in cardboard box:
MAC III Profile in single flightcase:
P/N 90206000
P/N 90206001
The MAC III Performance is a high-output profile moving head
with a new interleaved framing system with full crossover of
each blade and industry-first continuous rotation for new and
unlimited projection, framing and effects possibilities. It is
available as a stand-alone fixture or as an easy-to-swap module
that installs in minutes on any MAC III Profile.
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
AC power input: Neutrik PowerCon connector with 3 m cable tail
DMX and RDM data in/out: 5-pin locking XLR
Ethernet (Artnet II compatible, ACN-ready): Neutrik RJ-45 socket
(accepts Neutrik EtherCon connectors in housing)
USB memory devices: USB host socket
Future USB options: USB device socket
Features
• 1500 W short arc discharge
lamp with Lok-it!” base
• CMY color mixing system
• 7-position color wheel plus
open
• Variable CTO
• 5 indexable rotating gobos
• Framing of focused gobo
• Uniform dimming plus
mechanical shutter for total
blackout
• 1:5 zoom with focus tracking
• Gobo animation wheel with full
movement / direction control
• Continuous rotation, full blade
crossover framing with uniform
focus of each blade
• Motorized iris
• Mechanical and electronic
strobe effect 2 - 10 Hz, pulse
effects, instant open and
blackout
• Patented very low-noise
cooling. Quietest fixture in its
class
• Modular design for easy
maintenance, servicing and
product conversion
• Easy conversion between a
profile and performance - no
need to invest in two separate
fixtures
• Electronic ballast, fast lamp restrike and flicker free light
• Pan and tilt (540°/267°) with
absolute positioning control
• RDM ready, service USB and
Art-Net II prepared
• Battery-powered TFT display
and jog wheel navigation
43
MAC III Performance™
Specifications
Installation
PHYSICAL
Length (Head): Width: Height: Weight: 712 mm (28.0 in.)
536 mm (21.1 in.)
936 mm (36.9 in.)
54.9 kg (121.0 lbs.)
Mounting points: Orientation: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Minimum distance to combustible materials: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Any
2.5 m (8.2 ft.)
0.2 m (0.7 ft.)
Connections
LAMP
1500 W short-arc discharge
Osram HTI 1500W/60/P50
6000 K
>85
750 hours
Semi-hot (restrike in under 90 seconds)
PGJ50
Electronic
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color mixing: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
Color temperature control: CTO, variable 6000 - 3200 K
Color wheel: 7 interchangeable dichroic filters + open, indexing,
continuous rotation, random color
Rotating gobo wheel: Rotating gobo wheel with 5 interchangeable rotating gobos + open, gobo indexing, continuous rotation and shake
Rotating framing module: Continuously rotating framing module, can frame and morph
between squares, parallelograms and triangles or give complete blackout with one frame
Gobo animation: Interchangeable animation wheel, indexing, continuous rotation
with variable angle, speed and direction
Frost: Fixed and interchangeable
Iris: 0 - 100%, pulse effects
Mechanical dimmer: 0 - 100%, choice of four dimming curves
Mechanical shutter: Strobe effect 2 - 10 Hz, pulse effects, instant open and blackout
Focus: 2 m (6.6 ft.) to infinity
Zoom: Motorized
Zoom-focus linking system: 3-zone
Pan: 540°
Tilt: 268°
Position correction system: Absolute position monitoring
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
DMX channels: 33/40
Setting and addressing: Control panel with backlit graphic display and jog wheel or via DMX
16-bit control: Dimmer, gobo indexing (gobo wheel 1), frame rotation, focus, zoom, pan and tilt
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A, RDM
Receiver: Opto-isolated RS-485
Firmware update: USB memory device or USB/DMX hardware interface over DMX link
CONSTRUCTION
Color(s): Housing: Reflector: Protection rating: Black
Magnesium alloy, UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP20
Gobos
Size: E
Approved material: Borosilicate 3.3 or better with dichroic or heavy matted aluminum coating
Approved material: (metal gobos not approved)
Outside diameter: 37.5 mm (1.5 in.) +0/- 0.2 mm (0.01 in.)
Maximum image diameter: 30 mm (1.2 in.) +/- 0.4 mm (0.02 in.)
Maximum thickness: 1.1 mm (0.04 in.) +/- 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
AC power input: Neutrik PowerCon connector with 3 m (9.8 ft.) cable tail
DMX and RDM data in/out: 5-pin locking XLR
Ethernet (Artnet II compatible, ACN-ready): Neutrik RJ-45 socket
(accepts Neutrik EtherCon connectors in housing)
USB memory devices: USB host socket
Future USB options: USB device socket
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuses: 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
16 AT (x 2)
Thermal
Cooling: Filtered forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C (104° F): 170° C (338° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10% at 200 V, 60 Hz): 6160 BTU/hr
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
UL 1573
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Type: Fitted as standard: Color temperature: CRI (Color rendering index): Average lifetime: Hot restrike: Socket: Ballast: Included Items
Osram HTI 1500W/60/P50 lamp (installed): MAC III Performance Module (installed)
Tribal waves gobo animation wheel (installed): Two Omega clamp attachment brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners: P/N 97010347
P/N 62325143
P/N 91602001
Accessories
3 m power cable, 12 AWG, SJT, with PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector:
P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue:
P/N05342804
Philips MSR Gold 1500 Fastfit lamp: P/N 97010340
Four-facet prism in holder: P/N 62329120
Omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners: P/N 91602001
T-shaped omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners: P/N 91602008
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
G-clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only): P/N 91602003
Quick-trigger clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only): P /N 91602007
Swing-wing mounting plate with half-couplers: P/N 91602010
Super Truss 20.5” mounting plate with half-couplers: P/N 91602014
Safety wire, SWL 70 kg (154 lb.) P/N 91604004
MAC III Projection Module Kit (converts Performance to Profile) P/N 91614033
Ordering Information
MAC III Performance in cardboard box: MAC III Performance in single flightcase: P/N 90206200
P/N 90206210
Gobo Animation Wheel
Outside diameter: Image outer diameter: Image inner diameter: Thickness: Construction: 133.9 mm (5.3 in.) +/- 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
130 mm (5.1 in.)
32 mm (1.3 in.)
1.1 mm (0.04 in.) +/- 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
Borofloat or better with dichroic or enhanced aluminum coating
45
MAC III AirFX™
Specifications
Physical
Length (Head): Width: Height: Weight: 712 mm (28.0 in.)
536 mm (21.1 in.)
936 mm (36.9 in.)
54.9 kg (121.0 lbs.)
Lamp
1500 W short-arc discharge
6000 K
>85
750 hours
Semi-hot (restrike in under 90 seconds)
PGJ50
Electronic
Dynamic Effects
The MAC III AirFX is a highly versatile, mid-air effects luminaire
in Martin’s 1500-watt MAC III family. Capable of projecting a
dense, hard-edge beam with stunning mid-air aerial effects, the
fixture’s unique optical system allows it to adjust from a tight
beam to a radiant wash instantly for greater design flexibility.
Beam gobo projections can adjust along the entire zoom range
for a refreshingly diverse variety of mid-air looks. And unlike
other fixtures, light output is constant throughout the entire
zoom range with a fully linear zoom that gives no visible beam
jump from tight to wide.
Super bright, the MAC III AirFX is powerful enough to cut
through light from even the most powerful LED screens.
Features
• Beam, mid-air effects and
wash luminaire in one
• CMY color mixing plus color
wheel
• Variable CTO
• 1:5 linear zoom with no lumen
drop or internal lens changes
• Zoom with linked focus on all
aerial effects
• Fat beam
• 9" clear, precision PC lens with
less spill than micro-Fresnels
• Optional Fresnel lens
• Aerial effects: rotating and
replaceable
• Iris / Dimmer / Shutter
Color mixing: Color temperature control: Color wheel: Rotating aerial effects: Iris: Mechanical dimmer: Mechanical shutter: Focus: Zoom: Zoom-focus linking system: Wash effect: Pan: Tilt: Position correction system: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
CTO, variable 6000 - 3200 K
7 interchangeable dichroic filters + open, indexing,
continuous rotation, random color
Wheel with 4 interchangeable rotating aerial effects,
effect indexing, continuous rotation and shake
Variable, pulse effects
0 - 100%, choice of four dimming curves
Strobe effect, pulse effects, instant open and blackout
2 m (6.6 ft.) to infinity
Motorized
Automatic
Fade in/out
540°
268°
Absolute position monitoring
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Type: Color temperature: CRI (Color rendering index): Average lifetime: Hot restrike: Socket: Ballast: Control and Programming
DMX channels: 22
Setting and addressing: Control panel with backlit graphic display
and jog wheel or via DMX
RDM: Implemented
16-bit control: Dimmer, gobo indexing (gobo wheel 1), frame rotation,
focus, zoom, pan and tilt
DMX compliance: USITT DMX512-A
RDM compliance: ANSI/ESTA E1.20
Receiver: Opto-isolated RS-485
Firmware update: USB memory device or USB/DMX hardware interface over DMX link
Construction
Color(s): Housing: Reflector: Protection rating: Black
Magnesium alloy, UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP20
Installation
Mounting points: Orientation: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Minimum distance to combustible materials: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Any
2.5 m (8.2 ft.)
0.2 m (0.7 ft.)
Connections
AC power input: Neutrik PowerCon
DMX and RDM data in/out: 5-pin locking XLR
Ethernet (Artnet II compatible, ACN-ready): Neutrik RJ-45 socket
(accepts Neutrik EtherCon connectors in housing)
USB memory devices: USB host socket
Future USB options: USB device socket
47
MAC III Wash™
Specifications
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuses: 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
16 AT (x 2)
Thermal
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety (pending): Canadian safety (pending): EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-17
EN 55 015, EN 55 103-1, EN 61 547
ANSI/UL 1573
CAN/CSA E60598-1, CAN/CSA E598-2-17
Included Items
Lamp (installed)
Two Omega clamp attachment brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners: P/N 91602001
Accessories
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA
input connector, 3 m (9.8ft.): Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: Omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners: T-shaped omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners: Half-coupler clamp: G-clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only): Quick-trigger clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only): Super Truss 20.5” mounting plate with half-couplers: Swing-wing truss mounting plate with half-couplers: Safety wire, safe working load 70 kg (154.3 lbs.): P/N 11541503
P/N 05342804
P/N 91602001
P/N 91602008
P/N 91602005
P/N 91602003
P/N 91602007
P/N 91602014
P/N 91602010
P/N 91604004
Ordering Information
MAC III AirFX in cardboard box: MAC III AirFX in single flightcase: P/N 90206500
P/N 90206510
The MAC III Wash is a full-feature, full-range wash luminaire
with a unique internal barndoor system (shutters) that enables
designers to shape and control light projection onto stages,
performers, scenery, scrims or any set element with great
precision. It features an outstanding quality of light with
unlimited color choices and impressive power. Unlike other
fixtures, light output remains constant throughout the entire
zoom range with no visible beam jump when zooming from tight
to wide.
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Cooling: Filtered forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C (104° F): 170° C (338° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10% at 200 V, 60 Hz): 6160 BTU/hr
Features
• Powerful wash light with
internal barndoors
• 1:4 linear zoom with no lumen
drop or internal lens changes
• CMY color mixing plus color
wheel
• Variable CTO
• Iris
• Dimmer / Shutter
• 9 Fresnel lens
• Optional PC lens
Specifications
Physical
Length (Head): Width: Height: Weight: 712 mm (28.0 in.)
536 mm (21.1 in.)
936 mm (36.9 in.)
53.5 kg (117.9 lbs.)
Lamp
Type: Color temperature: CRI (Color rendering index): Average lifetime: Hot restrike: Socket: Ballast: 1500 W short-arc discharge
6000 K
>85
750 hours
Semi-hot (restrike in under 90 seconds)
PGJ50
Electronic
49
Specifications
Specifications
Dynamic Effects
Thermal
Control and Programming
DMX channels: Setting and addressing: RDM: 16-bit control: DMX compliance: RDM compliance: Receiver: Firmware update: 20
Control panel with backlit graphic display
and jog wheel or via DMX
Implemented
Dimmer, gobo indexing (gobo wheels 1 and 2),
focus, zoom, pan and tilt
USITT DMX512-A
ANSI/ESTA E1.20
Opto-isolated RS-485
USB memory device or USB/DMX hardware interface
over DMX link
PHOTOMETRIC DATA
Max. luminous flux: 48 000 lumens (narrow zoom), 44 000 lumens (wide zoom)
Max. luminous intensity: 5 900 000 candela (narrow zoom)
Photometric data is preliminary
Construction
Color(s): Housing: Reflector: Protection rating: Cooling: Filtered forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C (104° F): 170° C (338° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10% at 200 V, 60 Hz): 6160 BTU/hr
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety (pending): Canadian safety (pending): EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-17
EN 55 015, EN 55 103-1, EN 61 547
ANSI/UL 1573
CAN/CSA E60598-1, CAN/CSA E598-2-17
Included Items
Lamp (installed)
Two Omega clamp attachment brackets with 1/4-turn fasteners:P/N 91602001
Accessories
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector,
3 m (9.8ft.): P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount,
blue: P/N 05342804
Philips MSR Gold 1500 Fastfit lamp: P/N 97010340
Omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners: P/N 91602001
T-shaped omega clamp attachment bracket with 1/4-turn fasteners: P/N 91602008
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
G-clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only): P/N 91602003
Quick-trigger clamp (suspension with yoke vertically downwards only): P/N 91602007
Super Truss 20.5” mounting plate with half-couplers: P/N 91602014
Swing-wing truss mounting plate with half-couplers: P/N 91602010
Safety wire, safe working load 70 kg (154.3 lbs.): P/N 91604004
Flightcase for 1 x MAC III: P/N 91510080
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Color mixing: CMY, independently variable 0 - 100%
Color temperature control: CTO, variable 6000 - 3200 K
Color wheel: 7 interchangeable dichroic filters + open, indexing,
continuous rotation, random color
Beam shaping: Internal barn doors, continuously variable opening,
+55°/-55° indexed rotation
Iris: Variable, pulse effects
Mechanical dimmer: 0 - 100%, choice of four dimming curves
Mechanical shutter: Strobe effect 2 - 10 Hz, pulse effects,
instant open and blackout
Zoom: Motorized
Pan: 540°
Tilt: 268°
Position correction system: Absolute position monitoring
Ordering Information
MAC III Wash in cardboard box: MAC III Wash in single flightcase: P/N 90206520
P/N 90206530
Black
Magnesium alloy, UV-resistant fiber-reinforced composite
Glass, cold light
IP20
Installation
Mounting points: Orientation: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Minimum distance to combustible materials: 2 pairs of 1/4-turn locks
Any
2.5 m (8.2 ft.)
0.2 m (0.7 ft.)
Connections
AC power input: Neutrik PowerCon
DMX and RDM data in/out: 5-pin locking XLR
Ethernet (Artnet II compatible, ACN-ready): Neutrik RJ-45 socket
(accepts Neutrik EtherCon connectors in housing)
USB memory devices: USB host socket
Future USB options: USB device socket
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuses: 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
16 AT (x 2)
51
stagebar 2™
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Color control modes: RGBAW, RGB, HSI, HSIC
DMX channels: 3 - 30
Grouped pixel control options: 6 x 1 (individual), 3 x 2, 2 x 3 or 1 x 6 (all as one group) pixels
DMX address setting: Manual, auto addressing and auto address copy
Fixture setup: Onboard control panel with display
Display: Battery-powered backlit LCD, 2 x 16 characters
16-bit control (internal): RGBAW, RGB, HSI, HSIC
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver: RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
Color: Housing: Finish: Black
Steel and aluminum
Electrostatic powder-coatedProtection rating: IP20
INSTALLATION
Mounting points: Orientation:
Adjustable mounting bracket, 1/4-turn locks, four M6 threaded holes
Any
connections
Power in/out: PowerConData in/out: With twice the lumen output and 10 times the intensity of the
Stagebar 54™, the Stagebar 2 is an extremely capable LED
pixel bar and wash luminaire. This exceptional performance
is obtained by combining the latest LED technology with an
advanced lens design. The Stagebar 2 offers a wide range of
shades from an RGBAW color mixing system and is useful for
displaying imagery and video or for floodlighting surfaces and
stages.
Neutrik PowerCon
5-pin locking XLR
ELECTRICAL
AC power: Power supply unit: Power output fuse:
Main fuse: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
15 AT (slow blow)
4 AT (slow blow)
THERMAL
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
CONSTRUCTION
Cooling: Filtered forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 5° C (41° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C (104° F): 90° C (194° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10%): 860 BTU/hr.
APPROVALS
Features
• RGBAW color mixing system
for outstanding color palette
• Factory color calibration
• Over 3000 lm per ft (almost
10000 lm per meter)
• Super high intensity and tighter
beam due to advanced lens
design
• Opal diffuser lens for scenic
on-camera looks
• Quiet operation
• Daisy-chained power and data
• Battery-powered control menu
for off-site setup without power
Specifications
420 mm (16.5 in.)
630 mm (24.8 in.)
190 mm (7.5 in.)
105 mm (4.1 in.)
5.5 kg (12.1 lbs.) without bracket
7.3 kg (16.1 lbs.) without bracket
Dynamic Effects
Color mixing: Red: Green: Blue: Amber: White: EN 60598-2-17, EN 62471, EN 61347-2-13
EN 55015, EN 61547, EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2
UL 1573
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA E598-2-17
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
included items
Opal front cover
Narrow diffuser filter
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA male input connector: Omega clamp attachment bracket with quarter-turn fasteners: User manual: P/N 05342804
P/N 91602001
P/N 35000250
ACCESSORIES
PHYSICAL
Stagebar 2 S Length: Stagebar 2 L Length: Width: Height: Stagebar 2 S Weight: Stagebar 2 L Weight: EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: RGBAW
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
Power cable, AWG12, SJT, with Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA input connector, 3 m: P/N 11541503
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: P/N 05342804
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCB power output connector, cable mount, light grey:
P/N 05342805
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 1.4 m:
P/N 11850099
Power relay cable with PowerCon connectors, 2.25 m:
P/N 11850100
Set of 4 Narrow diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 S: P/N 91614035
Set of 4 Medium diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 S: P/N 91614036
Set of 4 Narrow diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 L: P/N 91614037
Set of 4 Medium diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 L: P/N 91614038
Adjustable floorstand/mounting bracket: P/N 71606007
ORDERING INFORMATION
Stagebar 2 S, RGBAW: Stagebar 2 L, RGBAW: P/N 90352070
P/N 90352090
53
Atomic 3000 DMX™
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Variable strobe: 0 - 650 ms (50 Hz supply), or 0 - 530 ms (60 Hz supply)
Strobe rate: 0 - 25 flashes/second (50 Hz supply), 0 - 30 flashes/second (60 Hz supply)
Blinder effect: Continuous with auto fade
Strobe intensity: Blackout - maximum
Special effects: Ramp up, ramp down, ramp up-down, random flash, lightning, spikes, blinder, single flash
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
CONSTRUCTION
Housing:
Finish: Color: Steel
Electrostatic powder-coated
Black
INSTALLATION
The Atomic 3000 DMX is a powerful and rugged, 3000 W highimpact strobe. It has been the industry’s favorite strobe light for
over a decade.
Features
• 3000 W long-life Xenon lamp included
• 5600 K color temperature
• Continuous blinder effect with auto fade
• Quiet temperature-controlled fan cooling
• Smart, integrated heat control eliminates cool down time
• Atomic Detonator remote control, socket kit for lamp change
• Auto-ranging power supply (100-240 V, 50/60 Hz)
• DMX, stand-alone, master/ slave or Detonator remote control
• Preprogrammed special effects
Minimum distance to combustible materials: 0.5 m (1.6 ft.)
Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: 1 m (3.3 ft.)
Minimum clearance around fan and air vents: 0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
Orientation: Any
Mounting points: Five 12 mm (0.5 in.) holes in mounting bracket
ELECTRICAL
AC power (MAX-7 model): 100-120 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
AC power (MAX-15 model): 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Peak current consumption: 33 A
Typical current consumption (MAX-15, high power mode): 8A
Power supply unit: Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, multi-fixture chase (with Detonator remote), MC-1
DMX channels: 1, 3, and 4 channel modes
Stand-alone control: Via N.O. or N.C. SPST switch
Stand-alone options: Selectable flash rate or blinder effect
Setting and addressing: DIP switch
Protocol: DMX512
Receiver: RS-485
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Maximum lamp socket temperature: 40° C (104° F)
120° C (248° F)
APPROVALS
US safety: Canadian safety: EU safety: EU EMC: UL 1573
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 166
EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 61547, EN55103-1
INCLUDED ITEMS
MAX-15 Xenon lamp (installed, EU model):
MAX-7 Xenon lamp (installed, US model):
P/N 97010307
P/N 97010308
ACCESSORIES
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 425 mm (16.7 in.) without bracket
245 mm (9.6 in.) without bracket
240 mm (9.4 in.) without bracket
7.5 kg (16.5 lbs.) without bracket
Atomic Detonator:
Atomic Colors for Atomic 3000:
G-Clamp:
Half-coupler clamp:
P/N 90760020
P/N 91611086
P/N 91602003
P/N 91602005
ORDERING INFORMATION
Atomic, EU model:
Atomic, US model:
P/N 90424200
P/N 90424300
LAMP
Type: Approved lamps: Xenon discharge
MAX-15 Xenon (200-250 V power), MAX-7 Xenon (90-120 V power)
55
Atomic Colors™
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color gel scrolling: 10 colors, custom gel strings can be fabricated
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: DMX
DMX channels: 1 or 2
Cooling fan speed control: Onboard control panel or DMX
Gel scrolling speed, ‘gel saver’ mode, light-activated fan operation:
Onboard control panel
Setting and addressing: Three-button LED control panel
Protocol: USITT DMX512/1990
Housing: Finish: Color(s): Gel frame capacity: Steel
Electrostatic powder-coated
Black
2-11 gel frames
INSTALLATION
Mounting device: Orientation: Dedicated mounting for the Atomic 3000 DMX
Any
ELECTRICAL
Atomic Colors is a specially designed head which fits onto
the front of the Atomic 3000 DMX allowing up to ten brightly
colored strobe and blinder effects.
DC voltage: DC current: Compatible power supplies: 24 V DC (+/- 10%)
O.55 A (Max.)
MPU-02, MPU-08
THERMAL
Cooling: Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Forced air, 4-speed fans
40° C (104° F)
INCLUDED ITEMS
10-color standard gel string (installed):
5 m power/data cable, 4-pin XLR:
Features
• 1 gel string included with 10 colors plus clear
• Quiet fan cooling
• Multiple modes, e.g. gel saver mode, action mode and monitor mode
• Safety wire
P/N 91611090
P/N 11821014
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
CONSTRUCTION
ACCESSORIES
• MPU-02 or MPU-08 for powering either 2 or 8 Atomic Colors
• On board memory with monitor and resetting
• DMX control
• DMX address via display
MPU-02 Power supply:
MPU-08 Power supply:
P/N 91611084
P/N 91611085
ORDERING INFORMATION
Atomic Colors for Atomic 3000:
P/N 91611086
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Color gel thickness: 470 mm (18.5 in.)
273 mm (10.7 in.)
102 mm (4.0 in.)
2.5 kg (5.5 lbs.)
0.075 mm (0.003 in.) - 0.125 mm (0.005 in.)
57
Detonator™
PLAYBACK
Run/stop toggle
Strobe rate: 0 - 25 Hz (50 Hz mains), 0 - 30 Hz (60 Hz mains)
Intensity: 0 - 100%
Chase/sync toggle for use with multiple fixtures
Single flash
Flash synchronization
Blinder effect: Triggering with variable intensity
CONSTRUCTION
Steel
Black
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU EMC: EN 60950
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2
INCLUDED ITEMS
5 m data cable, 3-pin XLR:
P/N 11820008
ORDERING INFORMATION
Detonator, Atomic Remote Control:
The Detonator is an optional, dedicated remote control tool for easy
command of the Atomic strobe’s flash rate and intensity. It includes
“blinder effect” and “single flash” detonator buttons as well as a
chase/synchronization toggle switch. Easy to set up and operate,
the Atomic Detonator requires no external power source.
P/N 90760020
ENTERTAINMENT LIGHTING
Housing: Color(s): Features
• Dedicated remote control for Atomic strobe series
• Fader-controlled flash rate and intensity
• Single button for Detonator blinder effect
• Separate button for single flash and flash sync
• Chase effect operation with multiple units
• Easy set-up and operation
• No external power necessary
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 142 mm (5.6 in.)
113 mm (4.4 in.)
75 mm (3.0 in.)
0.7 kg (1.5 lbs.)
59
• Tripix 1200 and 300
ARCHITECTURAL
LIGHTING
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Exterior 50 IP68
Exterior 100 IP68
Tripix Wash
Exterior 200
Exterior 400
Exterior 410
Exterior 420
Exterior 430
Exterior 600
Exterior 1200 Wash
Inground 200
• Exterior 400 Image Projector
• Exterior 1200 Image Projector
• FiberSource QFX150
• FiberSource CMY150
61
Tripix 300™ and 1200™
DMX address setting: Protocol: Receiver: Firmware update: Martin MUM™ application running on Windows PC
USITT DMX512-A
RS-485
Serial upload via DMX link
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Finish: Front cover: End covers: Mounting brackets: Protection rating: Aluminum
Clear anodized
Flame-retardant PMMA
Aluminum
Aluminum
IP66
Orientation: Aiming: Mounting: Distance between strips: Connections
The Tripix 300 and Tripix 1200 are attractively designed IP66-rated
LED strips using tricolor LEDs for superior color mixing directly
at the lens. The result is an absence of color shadows and a
broad color palette, including stunning whites, subtle pastels and
vibrant saturated colors.
Features
electrical
AC power: Standby power: Power output: • Quick installation using IP66
cabling system
• Available in 300 mm (1 ft)
and 1200 mm (4 ft) lengths in
various beam angles
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Tripix 300: 300 mm (11.8 in.), Tripix 1200: 1200 mm (47.2 in.)
61 mm (2.4 in.) including mounting bracket
82 mm (3.2 in.) including mounting bracket and DIN rail
Tripix 300: 1200 g (42.3 oz.), Tripix 1200: 4230 g (149.2 oz.)
OPTICS
Light source: Total LED power: Beam angle: CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Color control modes: Control system: DMX channels: Grouped pixel control options: 447 mm (17.6 in.)
141 mm (5.6 in.)
68 mm (2.7 in.)
5.8 kg (12.8 lbs.)
314 mm (12.4 in.)
68 mm (2.7 in.)
39 mm (1.5 in.)
1.5 kg (3.3 lbs.)
RGB 3-in-1 LED, approx. 3 W per LED
Tripix 300: approx 24 W, Tripix 1200: approx. 82 W
Narrow, medium and wide available
RGB (raw and calibrated), HSI, HSIC (calibrated)
DMX, stand-alone, master/slave
3 or 4 per 300 mm (11.8 in.)
Divided into sections of 300, 600 or 1200 mm (47.2 in.)
Male (C14) IEC chassis connector
Hard-wired (terminal block) via cable gland
IP66 13-pin DIN cable tail system
100-120/200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz (input to Tripix Power device)
300 mm (11.8 in.) models, 3 W / 1200 mm (47.2 in.) models, 10 W
48 V DC (output from Tripix Power device)
APPROVALS
• Uniform color mixing using
powerful tricolor LEDs
• No color separation or
shadows
• Easy to control: 64 built-in
programs and auto addressing
Tripix 300 and 1200
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Tripix Power
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Tripix Power IP66
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Tripix Power power input: Tripix Power IP66 power input: Fixture-to-fixture power and data: Any
Any angle between +/- 105°
35 mm (1.4 in.) DIN rail
Extendable (see User Manual)
EU safety: LED Safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1
IEC 60825-1, IEC 62471
EN 55015, EN 55103, EN 61 000-3-2
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C.22.2 No. 250
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
INSTALLATION
included items
Included with Tripix 300 and 1200 fixtures:
Tripix striplight fixture with narrow diffuser
Safety leaflet
2 x lengths Short DIN rail, 35 mm (1.4 in.)
Included with Tripix Power:
EU-type power cable with Schuko connector
US-type power cable without mains plug
Included with Tripix Power and Tripix Power IP66:
Tripix power inserter cable (3-way, power and data insertion)
Tripix DMX Termination Plug
User Manual
accessories
Tripix DMX Input Adapter: Tripix DMX Output Adapter: Tripix Cable Adapter extension connector set: Set of 8 Tripix Diffusers, Narrow, 304 mm (12.0 in.): Set of 8 Tripix Diffusers, Medium, 304 mm (12.0 in.): Set of 8 Tripix Diffusers, Wide, 304 mm (12.0 in.): All diffuser installation by Martin Service only
Tripix Front Cover: 0.5 m (1.6 ft.) Tripix Extension Cable:
1 m (3.3 ft.) Tripix Extension Cable: 5 m (16.4 ft.) Tripix Extension Cable: Tripix DMX Termination Plug: Tripix Power Inserter (3-way power and data insertion cable): ordering information
Tripix 300: Tripix 1200: Tripix Power: Tripix Power IP66:
P/N 91611337
P/N 91611338
P/N 91611323
P/N 91611329
P/N 91611330
P/N 91611331
P/N 91611332
P/N 91611335
P/N 91611334
P/N 91611333
P/N 91611336
P/N 91611339
P/N 90354520
P/N 90354530
P/N 90760310
P/N 90760330
63
Exterior 50 IP68™
Construction
Color: Steel grey (custom colors available upon request)
Housing: Aluminum with micro-arc oxidation coating, stainless steel protection frame
Mounting bracket: 1.5 mm (0.1 in.) stainless steel
Front glass: Polycarbonate with UV and mechanical protection coating
Protection rating: IP68
Installation
Orientation: Any
Vertical aiming: 330°
Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: 0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
Mounting: Direct surface mount, DIN rail, mounting bracket, ground stake
Features
• One high-power pre-mixed
LED: no color separation or
shadows
• Broad color palette (RGBW)
• Color calibration ensuring
uniform colors across fixtures
• White light options: Cold,
Neutral and Warm White
• Extremely rugged outdoor /
underwater design (IP68)
• Discreet low voltage cabling
• Choice of narrow or medium
beam angles
• DMX control
IP68 cable gland
3 m (9.8 ft.) cable tail
Electrical
Power supply unit: AC power: AC power (input to PSU): AC power (input to US model PSU): System power (output from PSU):
Standby power: Power supply unit: External PSU in IPX7-rated housing
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz (EU), 60 Hz (US)
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
100-240 V nominal, 60 Hz
20 - 40 VDC (36 VDC nominal)
0.42 W per fixture
External, Exterior 50/100 PSU
Thermal
Cooling: Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): Convection
45° C (113° F)
-30° C (-22° F), power must be
maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 1598, UL 8750
US safety approvals apply to the entire system using the US model PSU.
Included Items
Specifications
Adjustable mounting bracket
User manual
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Combined power/data cable entry: Combined power/data cable: ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Connections
The Exterior 50 IP68 is an exceptionally rugged and compact
lighting fixture designed for extreme outdoor and underwater
environments, such as fountains, pools, building facades,
landscaping, cruise ships - you name it. Ideal for applications
requiring superb color mixing (RGBW) or high quality white
light (cold, neutral or warm).
130 mm (5.1 in.) including cable gland
87 mm (3.4 in.) including mounting/tilt adjustment fasteners
117 mm (4.6 in.) including mounting bracket
660 g (23.3 oz.) including mounting bracket
Power Supply Unit, EU model
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 355 mm (14.0 in.)
146 mm (5.7 in.) including cable glands
83 mm (3.3 in.)
2.8 kg (6.2 lbs.)
Dynamic Effects
Color mixing:
Intensity: RGBW (standard model)
0 - 100% (all models)
Optics
Light source: Minimum LED lifetime: Cree MC-E high-power emitters
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Control and Programming
Color control modes: RGB, RGBW, W
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, infrared remote
DMX channels: 1, 3, and 4 channel modes
DMX address setting: PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface, IR remote
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer
Stand-alone programming: PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface
Dimming resolution: 14-bit (internal)
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver: RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
Accessories
Exterior 50 & 100 PSU: P/N 90510150
Exterior 50 & 100 Splitter: P/N 90510160
Exterior 50 & 100 compound set: P/N 90510220
Exterior 50 & 100 gel jacket: P/N 90510230
Exterior 50 & 100 infrared remote control: P/N 90510210
Exterior 50 light shield, narrow: P/N 90510270
Exterior 50 light shield, medium: P/N 90510280
Exterior 50 light shield, wide: P/N 90510290
Exterior 50 & 100 fixture link hybrid cable with connector, 10 m (32.8 ft.): P/N 90510200
Exterior 50 & 100 splitter link hybrid cable, 25 m (82.0 ft.): P/N 90510170
Exterior 50 & 100 splitter link hybrid cable, 50 m (164.0 ft.): P/N 90510180
Exterior 50 & 100 splitter link hybrid cable, 100 m (328.1 ft.): P/N 90510190
Exterior 50 & 100 telescopic bracket: P/N 90510300
Exterior 50 & 100 mounting bracket: P/N 90510310
Exterior 50 & 100 ground stake: P/N 90510320
Ordering Information
Exterior 50 & 100 PSU (Power Supply Unit), EU model: Exterior 50 & 100 PSU (Power Supply Unit), US model: Exterior 50 & 100 Splitter
Exterior 50 IP68 RGBW, Medium: Exterior 50 IP68 CW, Narrow: Exterior 50 IP68 CW, Medium: Exterior 50 IP68 NW, Narrow: Exterior 50 IP68 NW, Medium: Exterior 50 IP68 WW, Narrow: Exterior 50 IP68 WW, Medium: P/N 90510150
P/N 90510155
P/N 90510160
P/N 90510080
P/N 90510090
P/N 90510100
P/N 90510110
P/N 90510120
P/N 90510130
P/N 90510140
65
Exterior 100 IP68™
Construction
Color: Steel grey (custom colors available upon request)
Housing: Aluminum with micro-arc oxidation coating, stainless steel protection frame
Mounting bracket: 1.5 mm (0.1 in.) stainless steel
Front glass: Polycarbonate with UV and mechanical protection coating
Protection rating: IP68
Installation
Orientation: Any
Vertical aiming: 330°
Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: 0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
Mounting: Direct surface mount, DIN rail, mounting bracket, ground stake
Features
Electrical
Power supply unit: AC power: AC power: AC power (input to US model PSU): Standby power: Power supply unit: IP68 cable gland
3 m (9.8 ft.) cable tail
External PSU in IPX7-rated housing
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz (EU), 60 Hz (US)
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
100-240 V nominal, 60 Hz
0.42 W per fixture
External, Exterior 50/100 PSU
Thermal
• Four high power pre-mixed
LEDs: no color separation or
shadows
• Broad color palette (RGBW)
• Color calibration ensuring
uniform colors across fixtures
• White light options: Cold,
Neutral and Warm White
• Extremely rugged outdoor /
underwater design (IP68)
• Discreet low voltage cabling
• Choice of narrow or medium
beam angles
• DMX control
Cooling: Convection
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 45° C (113° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): -30° C (-22° F),
power must be maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 1598, UL 8750
US safety approvals apply to the entire system using the US model PSU.
Included Items
Adjustable mounting bracket
User manual
Specifications
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Combined power/data cable entry:
Combined power/data cable: ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Connections
The Exterior 100 IP68 is an exceptionally rugged and compact
lighting fixture designed for extreme outdoor and underwater
environments, such as fountains, pools, building facades,
landscaping, cruise ships - you name it.
Ideal for applications requiring superb color mixing (RGBW) or
high quality white light (cold, neutral or warm).
165 mm (6.5 in.) including cable gland
127 mm (5.0 in.) including mounting/tilt adjustment fasteners
166 mm (6.5 in.) including mounting bracket
1.39 kg (3.1 lbs.) including mounting bracket
Power Supply Unit, eu model
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 355 mm (14.0 in.)
146 mm (5.7 in.) including cable glands
83 mm (3.3 in.)
2.8 kg (6.2 lbs.)
Dynamic Effects
Color mixing: Intensity: RGBW (standard model)
0 - 100% (all models)Optics
Optics
Light source: Minimum LED lifetime: Cree MC-E high-power emitters
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Control and Programming
Color control modes: RGB, RGBW, W
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, infrared remote
DMX channels: 1, 3, and 4 channel modes
DMX address setting: PC with Martin MUM software and
DABS 1 hardware interface, IR remote
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer
Stand-alone programming: PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface
Dimming resolution: 14-bit (internal)
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver: RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
Accessories
Exterior 50 & 100 PSU: Exterior 50 & 100 Splitter: Exterior 50 & 100 compound set: Exterior 50 & 100 gel jacket: Exterior 50 & 100 infrared remote control: Exterior 100 light shield, narrow: Exterior 100 light shield, medium: Exterior 100 light shield, wide: Exterior 50 & 100 fixture link hybrid cable with connector, 10 m (32.8 ft.): Exterior 50 & 100 splitter link hybrid cable, 25 m (82.0 ft.): Exterior 50 & 100 splitter link hybrid cable, 50 m (164.0 ft.): Exterior 50 & 100 splitter link hybrid cable, 100 m (328.1 ft.): Exterior 50 & 100 telescopic bracket: Exterior 50 & 100 mounting bracket: Exterior 50 & 100 ground stake: Ordering Information
Exterior 50 & 100 PSU (Power Supply Unit), EU model: Exterior 50 & 100 PSU (Power Supply Unit), US model: Exterior 50 & 100 Splitter
Exterior 100 IP68 RGBW, Narrow: Exterior 100 IP68 RGBW, Medium: Exterior 100 IP68 CW, Narrow: Exterior 100 IP68 CW, Medium:
Exterior 100 IP68 NW, Narrow: Exterior 100 IP68 NW, Medium: Exterior 100 IP68 WW, Narrow: Exterior 100 IP68 WW, Medium: P/N 90510150
P/N 90510160
P/N 90510220
P/N 90510230
P/N 90510210
P/N 90510240
P/N 90510250
P/N 90510260
P/N 90510200
P/N 90510170
P/N 90510180
P/N 90510190
P/N 90510300
P/N 90510310
P/N 90510320
P/N 90510150
P/N 90510155
P/N 90510160
P/N 90510000
P/N 90510010
P/N 90510020
P/N 90510030
P/N 90510040
P/N 90510050
P/N 90510060
P/N 90510070
67
Tripix Wash™
Control and Programming
Color control modes: RGB (raw and calibrated), HSI (calibrated) HSIC (uncalibrated)
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 3 or 4 depending on mode
Grouped pixel control options: 1-, 2- and 4-pixel modes
DMX address setting: Martin MUM™ application running on Windows PC
RDM: Implemented
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver:
RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
Construction
Aluminum
Grey
Toughened glass
IP66
Installation
The Tripix Wash is an attractively designed IP66-rated fixture
using tricolor LEDs for superior color mixing directly at the lens.
The result is an absence of color shadows and a broad color
palette, including stunning whites, subtle pastels and vibrant
saturated colors. The Tripix Range can be used in a variety of
indoor and outdoor applications and installs in minutes using a
slim IP66 cable connector.
Features
• Uniform color mixing using
powerful tricolor LEDs
• No color separation or
shadows
• Easy to control: 64 built-in
programs and auto addressing
• Quick installation using IP66
cabling system
• Very Narrow, Narrow, Medium
and Wide beam angles
PHYSICAL
335 mm (13.2 in.)
213 mm (8.4 in.) including mounting bracket
66 mm (2.6 in.) including mounting bracket
4.4 kg (9.7 lbs.)
447 mm (17.6 in.)
141 mm (5.6 in.)
68 mm (2.7 in.)
5.8 kg (12.8 lbs.)
314 mm (12.4 in.)
68 mm (2.7 in.)
39 mm (1.5 in.)
1.5 kg (3.3 lbs.)
Optics
Light source: Total LED power: Beam angle: Any
22° down, 141° up
+/- 90°
Connections
Tripix Power power input: Tripix Power IP66 power input: Fixture-to-fixture power and data:
Male (C14) IEC chassis connector
Hard-wired (terminal block) via cable gland
IP66 13-pin DIN cable tail system
Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz (input to Tripix Power and Tripix Power IP66)
Power supply unit: Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
Power output: 48 V DC (output from Tripix Power and Tripix Power IP66)
Standby power: <10 W
Approvals
EU safety: LED Safety:
EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1
IEC 60825-1, 2001; IEC 62471, 2006
EN 55 015, EN 55 103, EN 61 000-3
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C.22.2 No. 250
Included Items
Specifications
Tripix Wash
Width: Height: Depth: Weight: Tripix Power
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Tripix Power IP66
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Orientation: Vertical aiming: Horizontal aiming: ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Housing: Finish: Front cover: Protection rating: RGB 3-in-1 LED
72 W
Very narrow (no diffuser), narrow, medium and wide available
Included with Tripix Wash fixtures
Tripix Wash fixture with narrow diffuser installed
Safety leaflet
Included with Tripix Power:
EU-type power cable with Schuko connector
US-type power cable without mains plug
Included with Tripix Power and Tripix Power IP66:
Tripix power inserter cable (3-way, power and data insertion)
Tripix DMX Termination Plug
User manual
Accessories
Set of 4 Tripix Wash Diffusers, Narrow: Set of 4 Tripix Wash Diffusers, Medium: Set of 4 Tripix Wash Diffusers, Wide: Tripix DMX Input Adapter: Tripix DMX Output Adapter: Tripix Cable Adapter extension connector set: 0.5 m (1.6 ft.) Tripix Extension Cable:
1 m (3.3 ft.) Tripix Extension Cable: 5 m (16.4 ft.) Tripix Extension Cable: Tripix DMX Termination Plug: Tripix Power Inserter (3-way power and data insertion cable): P/N 91610038
P/N 91610036
P/N 91610037
P/N 91611337
P/N 91611338
P/N 91611323
P/N 91611335
P/N 91611334
P/N 91611333
P/N 91611336
P/N 91611339
Ordering Information
Tripix Wash: Tripix Power: Tripix Power IP66: P/N 90354540
P/N 90760310
P/N 90760330
Custom colors available by special order - please contact your Martin distributor for details
69
Exterior 200™
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 7
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone memory: 20 scenes
DMX address setting: MUM
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: MUM
CONSTRUCTION
Aluminum
Clear anodized
8 mm (0.3 in.) anodized aluminum
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
IP 65
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Horizontal aiming: Vertical aiming: Minimum distance to combustible materials: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: ELECTRICAL
AC power: Standby power:
The Exterior 200 series is a range of programmable 150 W
luminaires weatherproofed for dynamic illumination of facades,
structures, water features and monuments.
Features
• Weatherproof rating: IP65
• Extensive range of optical accessories
• Ellipsoidal beam shaping options
• DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
• Onboard light sensor
PHYSICAL
301 mm (11.9 in.)
310 mm (12.2 in.)
402 mm (15.8 in.)
15 kg (33.1 lbs.)
431 mm (17.0 in.)
310 mm (12.2 in.)
402 mm (15.8 in.)
16.6 kg (36.6 lbs.)
LAMP
Type: Approved lamps: Socket: Control: 150 W metal halide
Philips CDM-SA/T 150, GE CMH 150, Osram HSD 150/70
G12
Automatic and/or remote on/off
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color mixing: Cyan: Magenta: Yellow: Dimmer: THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): -20° C (-4° F), power must be maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C: 90° C (194° F)
Cooling: Convection
EU EMC: EU safety: US safety: Canadian safety: ACCESSORIES
CMY
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
EN 60598-2-3, EN 60598-2-5
UL 1573
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 166
Elliptical beamshaper kit for PC lens installed in VN models (gives 8° x 16° half-peak angle):
P/N 91610028
Elliptical beamshaper lens (gives 41° x 46° half-peak angle):
P/N 91610023
Snoot/barndoor kit:
P/N 91611031
Snoot/barndoor extensions kit:
P/N 91611032
Safety eyebolt:
P/N 91611239
ORDERING INFORMATION
Specifications
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Length (VN and N models): Width (VN and N models): Height (VN and N models): Weight (VN and N models): 208 V, 60 Hz / 230 V, 50 Hz / 245 V, 50 Hz / 277 V, 60 Hz
27W
APPROVALS
• 150 W metal halide lamp
• CMY color mixing system
• Choice of optical systems: very narrow, narrow, medium, wide or very wide
• 0-100% intensity control
• High optical performance: uniform distribution of light and color
Any
90°
330°
1 m (3.3 ft.)
0.5 m (1.6 ft.)
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Housing: Finish: Mounting bracket: Front glass: Protection rating: Exterior 200 CMY, VN, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, VN, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, VN, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, VN, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, N, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, N, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, N, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, N, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, M, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, M, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, M, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, M, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 38°, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 38°, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 38°, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 38°, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 42°, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 42°, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 42°, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, W 42°, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, VW, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, VW, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, VW, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 200 CMY, VW, 277 V, 60 Hz:
P/N 90509024
P/N 90509020
P/N 90509022
P/N 90509026
P/N 90509044
P/N 90509040
P/N 90509042
P/N 90509046
P/N 90509048
P/N 90509045
P/N 90509047
P/N 90509043
P/N 90509004
P/N 90509000
P/N 90509002
P/N 90509005
P/N 90509011
P/N 90509009
P/N 90509010
P/N 90509003
P/N 90509084
P/N 90509080
P/N 90509082
P/N 90509086
VN = Very Narrow (Long Barrel), N = Narrow (Long Barrel), M = Medium, W = Wide, VW = Very Wide
71
Exterior 400™
Control and Programming
Construction
Color: Housing: Mounting bracket: Front glass: Protection rating: Clear anodized, black or white
Anodized aluminum
8 mm (0.3 in.) anodized aluminum
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
IP65
Installation
For lighting designs requiring uniform color washes at great
distances, the Exterior 400 provides extremely bright light (5300
lm) at narrow to wide beam angles. Great for lighting the tops of
structures, up-lighting columns or reaching across long spaces,
the Exterior 400 also broadens your choice of colors by mixing
red, green, blue and white LEDs.
Features
• Extremely bright (5300 lm)
• Broad color palette (RGBW)
• Very low power consumption
(max 139 W)
• Choice of beam angles - 7.5°,
14.5°, 31°, 57°
• Color calibration ensuring
uniform colors across fixtures
• Internal power and control
• Super rugged IP65 housing
• Choice of white, black or
aluminum housing
• 0 – 100% intensity control
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 169 mm (6.7 in.) including cable gland
307 mm (12.1 in.)
401 mm (15.8 in.)
7.6 kg (16.8 lbs.) including bracket
Dynamic Effects
Color mixing: Red: Green: Blue: White: RGBW
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
Orientation: Vertical aiming: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Connections
Power cable entry: Power connection: Data cable entry: Data connection: IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) cable tail
IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) combined input + output cable tail
Electrical
AC power: Standby power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety (US model): Canadian safety (US model): Any
330°
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Color control modes: RGB, RGBW, HSI, HSIC
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 3 or 4 depending on mode
DMX address setting: PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: PC with Martin MUM software
and DABS 1 hardware interface
26-bit control (internal): RGB, RGBW, HSI, HSIC
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver: RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
13 W
Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
2.5 AT (slow blow)
EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1, IEC/EN 60825-1
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C.22.2 No. 250
Included Items
Adjustable mounting yoke
Narrow, Medium and Wide diffusers (supplied separately with product)
Accessories
Narrow beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Medium beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Wide beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Exterior 200 floor stand: Safety eyebolt: 3-pin male XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: 3-pin female XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: Ordering Information
Exterior 400, EU Model, Aluminum: Exterior 400, US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 400, EU Model, Black: Exterior 400, US Model, Black: Exterior 400, EU Model. White: Exterior 400, US Model, White: P/N 41600122
P/N 41600123
P/N 41600124
P/N 91611305
P/N 91611239
P/N 91611306
P/N 91611307
P/N 90545050
P/N 90545150
P/N 90545060
P/N 90545160
P/N 90545070
P/N 90545170
optics
Light source: Cree XP-E high power emitters
White LED: Neutral white, 5700 - 7000 K
Minimum LED lifetime: 50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
Very Narrow (no diffuser), Narrow, Medium and Wide beam angles available
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
73
Exterior 410™
Control and Programming
Construction
Color: Housing: Mounting bracket: Front glass: Protection rating: Clear anodized, black or white
Anodized aluminum
8 mm (0.3 in.) anodized aluminum
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
IP65
Installation
For lighting designs requiring perfect color mixing at the fixture
and no color separation, the Exterior 410 steps in with very
powerful pre-mixed LEDs. At 5600 lumens, the Exterior 410 is
also extremely bright and uses RGBW color mixing to provide a
wide and rich palette of colors.
Orientation: Vertical aiming: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Connections
Power cable entry: Power connection: Data cable entry: Data connection: IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) cable tail
IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) combined input + output cable tail
Electrical
Features
• Super even color mixing at the
fixture
• No color separation
• Extremely bright (5600 lm)
• Very low power consumption
(max 139 W)
• Choice of beam angles - 19°,
22°, 36°, 65°
• Color calibration ensuring
uniform colors across fixtures
• Internal power and control
• Super rugged IP65 housing
• Choice of white, black or
aluminum housing
• 0 – 100% intensity control
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety (US model): Canadian safety (US model): 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
13 W
Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
2.5 AT (slow blow)
EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1, IEC/EN 60825-1
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C.22.2 No. 250
Included Items
Adjustable mounting yoke
User manual
Narrow, Medium and Wide diffusers (supplied separately with product)
Accessories
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: AC power: Standby power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Approvals
169 mm (6.7 in.) including cable gland
307 mm (12.1 in.)
401 mm (15.8 in.)
7.6 kg (16.8 lbs.) including bracket
Dynamic Effects
Color mixing: Red: Green: Blue: White: optics
RGBW
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
Any
330°
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Color control modes: RGB, RGBW, HSI, HSIC
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 3 or 4 depending on mode
DMX address setting: PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: PC with Martin MUM software
and DABS 1 hardware interface
26-bit control (internal): RGB, RGBW, HSI, HSIC
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver: RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
Narrow beam angle kit (diffuser sheet):
Medium beam angle kit (diffuser sheet):
Wide beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Exterior 200 floor stand: Safety eyebolt: 3-pin male XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: 3-pin female XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: Ordering Information
Exterior 410, EU Model, Aluminum: Exterior 410, US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 410, EU Model, Black: Exterior 410, US Model, Black: Exterior 410, EU Model, White: Exterior 410, US Model, White: P/N 41600122
P/N 41600123
P/N 41600124
P/N 91611305
P/N 91611239
P/N 91611306
P/N 91611307
P/N 90545053
P/N 90545151
P/N 90545061
P/N 90545161
P/N 90545071
P/N 90545171
Light source: Cree MC-E high-power emitters
White LED: Neutral white, 5700 - 7000 K
Minimum LED lifetime:
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
Very Narrow (no diffuser), Narrow, Medium and Wide beam angles available
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
75
Exterior 420™
Stand-alone trigger options: Stand-alone and master/slave programming: 26-bit control (internal):
Protocol: Receiver: Firmware update: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
PC with Martin MUM software
and DABS 1 hardware interface
Color temperature control and intensity
USITT DMX512-A
RS-485
Serial upload via DMX link
Construction
Clear anodized, black or white
Anodized aluminum
8 mm (0.3 in.) anodized aluminum
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
IP65
Installation
Orientation: Vertical aiming: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Any
330°
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
Connections
For white light designs requiring the added flexibility of color
temperature control from warm to cold white, the Exterior 420
offers one of the most powerful white light units on the market,
with even output across a wide color temperature range.
Features
Power cable entry: Power connection: Data cable entry: Data connection: IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) cable tail
IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) combined input + output cable tail
Electrical
AC power: Standby power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
13 W
Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
2.5 AT (slow blow)
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Color: Housing: Mounting bracket: Front glass: Protection rating: Approvals
• Extremely bright white
light (5900 lm) with color
temperature control
• Very broad color temperature
range (2700 - 6500K)
• Very low power consumption
(max 139 W)
• Choice of beam angles
- 8°, 14°, 33°, 54°
• Color calibration ensuring
uniform colors across fixtures
• Internal power and control
• Super rugged IP65 housing
• Choice of white, black or
aluminum housing
• 0 – 100% intensity control
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 169 mm (6.7 in.) including cable gland
307 mm (12.1 in.)
401 mm (15.8 in.)
7.6 kg (16.8 lbs.) including bracket
Dynamic Effects
Color temperature control: Variable
optics
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety (US model): Canadian safety (US model): EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1, IEC/EN 60825-1
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C.22.2 No. 250
Included Items
Adjustable mounting yoke
Narrow, Medium and Wide diffusers (supplied separately with product)
User manual
Accessories
Narrow beam angle kit (diffuser sheet):
Medium beam angle kit (diffuser sheet):
Wide beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Exterior 200 floor stand: Safety eyebolt: 3-pin male XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: 3-pin female XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: P/N 41600122
P/N 41600123
P/N 41600124
P/N 91611305
P/N 91611239
P/N 91611306
P/N 91611307
Ordering Information
Exterior 420, EU Model, Aluminum: Exterior 420, US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 420, EU Model, Black: Exterior 420, US Model, Black: Exterior 420, EU Model, White: Exterior 420, US Model, White: P/N 90545051
P/N 90545152
P/N 90545062
P/N 90545162
P/N 90545072
P/N 90545172
Light source: Cree XP-E high power emitters
Minimum LED lifetime: 50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
Very Narrow (no diffuser), Narrow, Medium and Wide beam angles available*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Control and Programming
Color control modes: Control options: DMX channels: DMX address setting: Color temperature control and intensity
DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
2
PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface
77
Exterior 430™
DMX address setting: PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: PC with Martin MUM software
and DABS 1 hardware interface
26-bit control (internal): Single color intensity
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver: RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
Construction
Clear anodized, black or white
Anodized aluminum
8 mm (0.3 in.) anodized aluminum
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
IP65
Installation
Orientation: Vertical aiming: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Any
330°
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
Connections
Great for applications requiring just one color, the Exterior 430
offers very bright Red, Green, Blue, Warm White or Cold White
options. The Exterior 430 also uses a unique color calibration
system in its Red, Green and Blue units to ensure uniformity
across fixtures and over time, plus the added ability to adjust
colors to precisely match the look needed in your lighting
design. Color fades within a narrow range, such as magenta
blue turquoise, are also possible.
Features
• Extremely bright single color
(up to 7000 lm)
• Calibrated Red, Green or Blue
ensuring color consistency
• Adjustable color within Red,
Green or Blue color ranges
• Very low power consumption
(max 139 W)
• Choice of beam angles - 7.5°,
16°, 33°, 52°
• Internal power and control
• Super rugged IP65 housing
• Choice of white, black or
aluminum housing
• 0-100% intensity control
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 169 mm (6.7 in.) including cable gland
307 mm (12.1 in.)
401 mm (15.8 in.)
7.6 kg (16.8 lbs.) including bracket
Dynamic Effects
All Exterior 430 luminaires Single color or white: Red, green and blue luminaires Single color: 0 - 100% continuous dimming
Color fine tuning available
Optics
Light source:
Cree XP-E high power emitters
Color temperature:
2700 K (Warm white luminaires), 6500 K (Cold white luminaires)
Minimum LED lifetime:
50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)
Very Narrow (no diffuser), Narrow, Medium and Wide beam angles available*
* Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Control and Programming
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels:1 (white luminaires) or 1-4 depending on mode (red, green and blue luminaires)
Power cable entry: Power connection: Data cable entry:
Data connection: IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) cable tail
IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) combined input + output cable tail
Electrical
AC power: Standby power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
13 W
Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
2.5 AT (slow blow)
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Color: Housing: Mounting bracket: Front glass: Protection rating: Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety (US model): Canadian safety (US model): EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1, IEC/EN 60825-1
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C.22.2 No. 250
Included Items
Adjustable mounting yoke
Narrow, Medium and Wide diffusers (supplied separately with product)
User manual
Accessories
Narrow beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Medium beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Wide beam angle kit (diffuser sheet): Exterior 200 floor stand: Safety eyebolt: 3-pin male XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: 3-pin female XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: P/N 41600122
P/N 41600123
P/N 41600124
P/N 91611305
P/N 91611239
P/N 91611306
P/N 91611307
Ordering Information
The Exterior 430 is a custom product. Please contact your Martin sales contact or customer care representative at
time of ordering to give details of the LED color you require.
Exterior 430 Red, EU Model/US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 430 Red, EU Model/US Model, Black: Exterior 430 Red, EU Model/US Model, White: Exterior 430 Green, EU Model/US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 430 Green, EU Model/US Model, Black: Exterior 430 Green, EU Model/US Model, White: Exterior 430 Blue, EU Model/US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 430 Blue, EU Model/US Model, Black: Exterior 430 Blue, EU Model/US Model, White: Exterior 430 Cold White, EU Model/US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 430 Cold White, EU Model/US Model, Black: Exterior 430 Cold White, EU Model/US Model, White: Exterior 430 Warm White, EU Model/US Model, Aluminum: Exterior 430 Warm White, EU Model/US Model, Black:
Exterior 430 Warm White, EU Model/US Model, White:
P/N 90545052 / P/N 90545153
P/N 90545063 / P/N 90545163
P/N 90545073 / P/N 90545173
P/N 90545054 / P/N 90545154
P/N 90545064 / P/N 90545164
P/N 90545074 / P/N 90545174
P/N 90545055 / P/N 90545155
P/N 90545065 / P/N 90545165
P/N 90545075 / P/N 90545175
P/N 90545056 / P/N 90545156
P/N 90545066 / P/N 90545166
P/N 90545076 / P/N 90545176
P/N 90545057 / P/N 90545157
P/N 90545067 / P/N 90545167
P/N 90545077 / P/N 90545177
79
Exterior 600™
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 8/9
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone memory: 20 scenes
DMX address setting: MUM
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: MUM
Protocol: 
USITT DMX512/1990
Receiver: 
RS-485
CONSTRUCTION
Aluminum
Clear anodized
6 mm (0.2 in.) stainless steel
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated (except VN and VW models)
IP 65
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Any
Horizontal aiming: +/- 25°
Vertical aiming (pedestal mounted): +/- 40°
ELECTRICAL
The Exterior 600 is the leading 575 W intelligent luminaire
for dynamic and creative illumination of the built and natural
environments.
Features
• 575 W metal halide lamp
• CMY color mixing system
• Dynamic zoom for variable beam angles: 9°-12° / 11°- 27°
• Choice of optical systems: very narrow, narrow, medium, wide or very wide
• 0-100% intensity control
• High optical performance: uniform distribution of light and color
• Ellipsoidal beam shaping and frost filter options
• Weatherproof rating: IP65
• DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
• Onboard light sensor
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 636 mm (25.0 in.)
375 mm (14.8 in.)
421 mm (16.6 in.)
48 kg (105.8 lbs.)
LAMP
Type: Approved lamps: Socket: Control: 575 W metal halide
Philips MSD 575, Osram HSD 575/60
GX 9.5
Automatic and/or remote on/off
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color mixing: Cyan: Magenta: Yellow: Color wheel: Dimmer: Shutter: Frost: Zoom: Beamshaper: CMY
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
Red, green, blue, CTC (as standard) + open positions
0 - 100%
Strobe effect variable up to 8 Hz
On/off
9°- 12° / 11°- 27°
+/- 45° from vertical
AC power: Standby power: 208 V, 60 Hz / 230 V, 50 Hz / 245 V, 50 Hz / 277 V, 60 Hz
24W
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): -20° C (-4° F), power must be maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C: 80° C (176° F)
Cooling: Convection
APPROVALS
US safety: Canadian safety: EU safety: EU EMC: ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Housing: Finish: Mounting bracket: Front glass: Protection rating: UL 1573
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 166
EN 60598-2-3, EN 60598-2-5
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
INCLUDED ITEMS
Philips MSD 575 lamp:
P/N 97010202
ACCESSORIES
Elliptical beamshaper (for use with VN model only, gives 12° x 22° half-peak angle):
P/N 91610028
Permanent 5500 - 4200 K CTC kit:
P/N 91611036
Snoot/barndoor kit:
P/N 91611029
Extensions to Snoot/barndoor kit:
P/N 91611030
Safety eyebolt:
P/N 91611239
ORDERING INFORMATION
Exterior 600, VN, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, VN, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, VN, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, VN, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, N, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, N, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, N, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, N, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, M, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, M, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, M, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, M, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, W, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, W, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, W, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, W, 277 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, VW, 208 V, 60 Hz:
Exterior 600, VW, 230 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, VW, 245 V, 50 Hz:
Exterior 600, VW, 277 V, 60 Hz:
P/N 90505024
P/N 90505020
P/N 90505022
P/N 90505026
P/N 90505044
P/N 90505040
P/N 90505042
P/N 90505046
P/N 90505004
P/N 90505000
P/N 90505002
P/N 90505006
P/N 90505064
P/N 90505060
P/N 90505062
P/N 90505066
P/N 90505084
P/N 90505080
P/N 90505082
P/N 90505086
VN = Very Narrow, N = Narrow, M = Medium, W = Wide, VW = Very Wide
81
Exterior 1200 Wash™
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color mixing: Cyan: Magenta: Yellow: Color wheel: Dimmer: Zoom: CMY
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
Red, green, blue, CTC (as standard) + open positions
0 - 100%
8°- 16° / 12°- 26°
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
8
Internal timer and/or ambient light level
20 scenes
MUM, onboard control panel
MUM, onboard control panel
USITT DMX512-A
RS-485
CONSTRUCTION
The Exterior 1200 Wash is a powerful 1200 W luminaire designed
for spectacular illumination of high-rise structures, bridges and
landmark architecture.
Housing: Finish: 
Color: 
Front glass: 
Protection rating: 
Aluminum
Clear anodized
Light grey (RAL 9006)
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
UL wet location, main enclosure designed to IP65
INSTALLATION
Orientation:
Vertical aiming: Any (air intake must face down)
+/- 90°
ELECTRICAL
Features
• 1200 W metal halide lamp
• CMY color mixing system
• Dynamic zoom for variable beam angles: 8°- 16° / 12°- 26°
• Choice of optical systems: narrow, medium, wide or very wide
• 0-100% intensity control
• High optical performance: uniform distribution of light and color
• Weatherproof rating: IP65
• DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
• Onboard address setting: no extra devices required
AC power: Main fuse: Ballast: Standby power:
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 45° C (113° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): -20° C (-4° F),power must be maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=45° C: 70° C (158° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10%): 4950 BTU/hr.
Cooling: Forced air, integrated air/air heat exchanger, IP65 barrier
APPROVALS
US safety: Canadian safety: EU safety: EU EMC: INCLUDED ITEMS
PHYSICAL
ACCESSORIES
Philips MSD 1200 lamp:
860 mm (33.9 in.)
448 mm (17.6 in.)
620 mm (24.4 in.)
68 kg (149.9 lbs.)
0.6 m²
LAMP
Type: Fitted as standard: Socket: Control: 200/208/220/230/240/250/277 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
17.5 AT (slow blow)
Magnetic
18 W at 230 V
THERMAL
Specifications
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Effective Projected Area (EPA): 1200 W metal halide
Philips MSD 1200
G22
Automatic and/or remote on/off
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Control options: DMX channels: Stand-alone trigger options: Stand-alone memory: DMX address setting: Stand-alone programming: Protocol: 
Receiver: 
Beamshaper lens:
Narrow-angle lens kit:
Medium-angle lens kit:
Wide-angle lens kit:
Very wide-angle lens kit:
Permanent CTC kit:
Snoot/barndoor kit:
Dichroic color filters (install in color wheel)
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 250
EN 60598-1, EN 61347-1
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61000-3-2
P/N 97010313
P/N 91610081
P/N 91610088
P/N 91610089
P/N 91610090
P/N 91610091
P/N 91611258
P/N 91611257
ORDERING INFORMATION
Exterior 1200 Wash, Narrow:
Exterior 1200 Wash, Medium:
Exterior 1200 Wash, Wide:
Exterior 1200 Wash, Very Wide:
P/N 90504010
P/N 90504020
P/N 90504030
P/N 90504040
83
Inground 200™
Control and Programming (Inground 200 CMY)
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 6
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer
Stand-alone memory: 20 scenes
DMX address setting: Martin MUM™ application running on Windows PC
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: Martin MUM™ application
running on Windows PC
Protocol: USITT DMX512/1990
Receiver: RS-485
Construction
Features
• Weatherproof rating: IP65 and
IP67
• Full drive-over capability
• Low surface temperature for
installation in pedestrian areas
• Extensive range of optical
accessories
• DMX, stand-alone,
synchronized (master/slave)
Orientation: Minimum distance to combustible materials: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Uplight
1 m (3.3 ft.)
0.5 m (1.6 ft.)
3 m (9.8 ft.) hard-wired cable tail
3 m (9.8 ft.) hard-wired cable tail
Electrical
AC power: 210/277 V nominal, 60 Hz; 230 V nominal, 50 Hz
Thermal
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 35° C (95° F), higher if installation
is approved by Martin Architectural
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 20° C (-4° F), power must be
maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C: 80° C (176° F)
Cooling: Internal fan, conduction via installation site fill material
EU EMC: EU safety:
Canadian safety:
US safety: Physical
Height: Trim ring outer diameter: Trim ring thickness: Housing top flange outer Ø: Weight: Weight resistance (in installation
sleeve with stable groundwork): Front glass weight resistance (load from pneumatic tire): Installation sleeve
Installation sleeve height: Installation sleeve tube external Ø: Installation sleeve base flange external Ø: Power input: DMX data in/out (CMY models): Approvals
Specifications
496 mm (19.5 in.)
340 mm (13.4 in.)
7 mm (0.3 in.)
310 mm (12.2 in.)
20 kg (44.1 lbs.)
5000 kg (11,023.1 lbs.)
5000 kg (11,023.1 lbs.)
600 mm (23.6 in.)
334 mm (13.1 in.)
416 mm (16.4 in.)
Lamp
150 W metal halide
Philips CDM SA/T 150 W/942, Philips CDM-T 150 W/830,
Osram HCI-T 150 W/WDL, Osram HCI-T 150 W/NDL
G12
Automatic and/or remote on/off
Dynamic Effects [Inground 200 CMY]
Color mixing: Cyan: Magenta: Yellow: Mechanical dimmer: Installation
Connections
• 150 W metal halide lamp
• Choice of 2 color systems:
Single-color or full spectrum
CMY
• Choice of optical systems:
medium, wide, very wide or
wallwash
• 0-100% intensity control
• High optical performance:
uniform distribution of light
and color
Type: Approved lamps: Socket: Control: Aluminium
Black anodized
Stainless steel
Acid-resistant stainless steel
IP65/67
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
The Inground 200 series offers the benefits of dynamic light and
discreet buried installation combined in a simple, easy-to-use
system of programmable 150-watt luminaires.
Housing: Finish: Trim ring: Installation sleeve: Protection rating: CMY
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
EN 60598-2-5
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 250
UL 1598
Included Items
Philips CDM-SA/T 150 W lamp:
P/N 97010111
Accessories
Installation sleeve, bevelled mount:
Installation sleeve, flush mount:
25 kg (55.1 lbs.) rinsed, dried sand for installation:
Anti-glare kit, medium configuration (ring louver):
Anti-glare kit, wallwash configuration:
Anti-skid frontglass (circular etched):
Anti-skid frontglass (design etched):
Beamshaper module:
Rock guard kit, aluminium:
Rock guard kit, brass:
Rock guard kit, stainless steel:
Tamperproof trim ring screw set with key:
Trim ring kit, bevelled, brass:
Trim ring kit, bevelled, aluminium:
Trim ring kit, flush mount, aluminium:
Trim ring kit, flush mount, brass:
Trim ring kit, flush mount, stainless steel:
P/N 91611194
P/N 91611215
P/N 91611237
P/N 91611202
P/N 91611197
P/N 91611238
P/N 91611198
P/N 91611207
P/N 91611209
P/N 91611208
P/N 91611199
P/N 91611200
P/N 91611211
P/N 91611210
P/N 91611213
P/N 91611214
P/N 91611212
For full ordering information please consult www.martin.com
85
Exterior 400 Image Projector™
Optics
Light source: 7 x Luminus CBT-90 (50 W) LEDs
White LED: Neutral white, 3500 - 4500 K, CRI 75
Minimum LED lifetime (to 50% of initial output level): 30 000 hours at full intensity
Narrow, medium and wide available
Control and Programming
Photometric Data
Luminous flux: One-tenth peak angle: 7400 lm (with 25° lens)
15°, 25° and 40° options
Construction
The Exterior 400 Image Projector is a powerful tool for integrating
textures, patterns and graphics in outdoor lighting designs. At
over 7000 lumens, the fixture can be used for bright and dynamic
logo projection, as well as precision framing.
Using advanced LED technology, the Exterior 400 Image
Projector stands apart for its energy efficiency, compact size
and incredible design flexibility.
Color: Housing: Mounting bracket: Front glass: Protection rating: Clear anodized, white, custom colors to special order
Anodized aluminum
8 mm (0.3 in.) anodized aluminum
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
IP65
Installation
Orientation:
Vertical aiming: Minimum distance to illuminated surfaces: Any
330°
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: TBA
DMX address setting:
PC with Martin MUM software and DABS 1 hardware interface
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: PC with Martin MUM software and
DABS 1 hardware interface
Protocol: USITT DMX512-A
Receiver: RS-485
Firmware update: Serial upload via DMX link
Connections
Power cable entry: Power connection: Data cable entry: Data connection: IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) cable tail
IP68 cable gland
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) combined input + output cable tail
Electrical
Features
• Bright and energy efficient LED
projection (+7000 lumens)
• Up to six interchangeable gobos / patterns
• Up to eight interchangeable
colors
• Rugged IP65 housing
• Narrow, medium and wide
beam angle options
• Pre-programmable effects,
such as: continuous image
rotation, color scrolling, focus,
dimming
AC power: Standby power: Power supply unit: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
13 W
Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
Thermal
Cooling: Convection
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 5° C (113° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 30° C (-22° F), power must be
maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C (104° F): 75° C (167° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10%): 1570 BTU/hr.
Approvals
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 365 mm (14.4 in.) including cable gland
307 mm (12.1 in.) including mounting bracket
421 mm (16.6 in.) including mounting bracket
14 kg (30.9 lbs.)
Included Items
Adjustable mounting yoke
User manual
Accessories
Dynamic Effects
Color wheel: Rotating gobo wheel:
Motorized iris: Electronic dimming: Motorized focus: Pre-programmed effects: EU safety: EN 60598-1, EN 60598-2-1, IEC/EN 60825-1
EU EMC: EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
US safety (US model), pending: UL 1598
Canadian safety (US model), pending: CAN/CSA C.22.2 No. 250
8 interchangeable dichroic filters
+ open, full and split colors, continuous rotation, random color
6 interchangeable gobos + open, indexing,
continuous gobo rotation & scrolling, shake
0 - 100%, pulse effects
0 - 100% dimming, strobe effects
2 m (6.6 ft.) to infinity
Full range of macro effects
Safety eyebolt: 3-pin male XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: 3-pin female XLR connector, cable-type, IP65: P/N 91611239
P/N 91611306
P/N 91611307
Ordering Information
Exterior 400 IP EU with 25° Lens: Exterior 400 IP US with 25° Lens: P/N 90507050
P/N 90507060
Custom colors available by special order - please contact your Martin distributor for details
87
Exterior 1200 Image Projector™
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color mixing: CMY
Color wheel: 4 slots for interchangeable filters
Rotating gobo wheel: 4 interchangeable gobo positions (one required for open), gobo indexing, continuous gobo rotation
Gobo animation: Interchangeable animation wheel, indexing, continuous rotation with variable angle, speed and direction
Mechanical dimmer/shutter: 0 - 100% variable dimming, instant open and blackout
Focus: 3 m (9.8 ft.) to infinity
Zoom: Narrow 12° - 18°, medium 18° - 36°, wide 31° - 51°, cut-off angles
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
CONSTRUCTION
The Exterior 1200 Image Projector is a powerful 1200-watt
luminaire designed for projecting animated images and effects
onto structures and landmark architecture.
Features
• 1200 W metal halide lamp
• CMY color mixing system
• Color wheel with primary colors red, green and blue
• 0-100% intensity control
• High optical performance:
uniform distribution of light
and color
• Choice of narrow, medium or
wide beam options
• Dynamic zoom for variable
beam angles: 11°- 17° / 17°34° / 30°- 48°
• Motorized zoom and focus
• 4 D-size gobo slots for
projecting graphic images
• Gobo animation system for
creating animated lighting
effects
• Weatherproof rating: IP65
• DMX, stand-alone,
synchronized (master/slave)
• Onboard address setting:
no extra devices required
Housing: Finish: Color: Front glass: Color wheel filters: Protection rating: Aluminum
Clear anodized
Light grey (RAL 9006)
6 mm (0.2 in.) anti-reflection coated
1.2 mm (0.05 in.), dichroic, hexangular
UL wet location, main enclosure designed to IP65
GOBOS
Material: Size: Outside diameter: Maximum image diameter: Maximum thickness: Image orientation: Metal or glass
D
53.3 mm (2.1 in.) +0/- 0.3 mm (0.01 in.)
48 mm (1.9 in.)
2 mm (0.08 in.)
True from lamp side
INSTALLATION
Orientation:
Vertical aiming: ELECTRICAL
AC power: Main fuse: Ballast: Standby power: Any (air intake must face down)
+/- 90°
200/208/220/230/240/250/277 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
17.5 AT (slow blow)
Magnetic
20 W
THERMAL
Cooling: Forced air, integrated air/air heat exchanger, IP65 barrier
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 45° C (113° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): -20° C (-4° F), power must be maintained below 0° C (32° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=45° C: 70° C (158° F)
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10%): 4950 BTU/hr.
APPROVALS
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Effective Projected Area (EPA): 1006 mm (39.6 in.)
448 mm (17.6 in.)
620 mm (24.4 in.)
90 kg (198.4 lbs.)
0.8 m²
LAMP
Type: Fitted as standard: Socket: Control: 1200 W metal halide
Philips MSD 1200
G22
Automatic and/or remote on/off
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 17
DMX address setting: MUM, onboard control panel
16-bit control: Mechanical dimmer, rotating gobo indexing/speed, focus, zoom
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone memory: 20 scenes
US safety: Canadian safety: EU safety: EU EMC:
ACCESSORIES
Narrow-angle lens kit:
Medium-angle lens kit:
Wide-angle lens kit:
Permanent 5500 - 4200 K CTC kit:
Permanent 5500 - 3400 K CTC kit:
Snoot/barndoor kit:
Beamshaper lens:
ORDERING INFORMATION
Exterior 1200 Image Projector, Narrow:
Exterior 1200 Image Projector, Medium:
Exterior 1200 Image Projector, Wide:
UL 1598
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 250
EN 60598-1, EN 61347-1
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61000-3-2
P/N 91610083
P/N 91610084
P/N 91610085
P/N 91611273
P/N 91611272
P/N 91611257
P/N 91610082
P/N 90504065
P/N 90504075
P/N 90504085
89
FiberSource QFX150™
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color wheel: Twinkle effect: Dimmer: 9 positions + open, continuous rotation
Removable section, continuous variable-speed rotation
0 - 100%
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 5
DMX address setting: DIP switch
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: DIP switch
CONSTRUCTION
Steel and aluminum
Electrostatic powder-coated
Black (RAL 9005)
IP 20
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Minimum distance to combustible materials: Minimum clearance around fan and air vents: Horizontal
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
ELECTRICAL
AC power: Main fuse: The FiberSource QFX150 is an automated 150-watt colorchanging luminaire for illuminating fiber optic cables in
permanent installations. It features a color wheel with 9
interchangeable colors and smooth, full-range mechanical
dimming.
Features
• 150 W metal halide lamp
• Color wheel with up to 9 interchangeable colors (4 are included)
• 0-100% intensity control
• Up to 800 fiber cables (1 mm)
• Blackout and strobe functionality
• Twinkle wheel for sparkling effects
• DMX or stand-alone control
100/120/210/230/250 V, 50/60 Hz
5 AT (slow blow)
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C: Cooling: Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10%): 40° C (104° F)
58° C (136° F)
Forced air cooling system
700 BTU/hr.
APPROVALS
US safety:
Canadian safety: EU safety: EU EMC: ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Housing: Finish: Color: Protection rating:
UL 153
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 12
EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
INCLUDED ITEMS
Osram HQI-R 150 lamp:
3 m (9.8 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC:
5 m (16.4 ft.) data cable, 3-pin XLR:
Blue 108 color filter on adaptor:
Yellow 603 color filter on adaptor:
Green 206 color filter on adaptor:
Red 308 color filter on adaptor:
P/N 97010101
P/N 11501013
P/N 11820008
P/N 62327030
P/N 62327031
P/N 62327033
P/N 62327032
ACCESSORIES
Fiber adaptor, 75-350 pcs.: (25 pcs. interval) Ø 1 mm (0.04 in.) fiber, D= 30 mm (1.2 in.):
P/N 91611035
G-clamp:
P/N 91602003
Half-coupler clamp:
P/N 91602005
Optional color filters: See user manual
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 330 mm (13.0 in.)
213 mm (8.4 in.)
199 mm (7.8 in.)
10.4 kg (22.9 lbs.)
ORDERING INFORMATION
FiberSource QFX 150:
P/N 90522000
LAMP
Type: Approved lamps: Socket: Control: 150 W metal halide
Osram HQI-R 150
Separate connector for integral lamp wires
Remote on/off
91
FiberSource CMY150™
DYNAMIC EFFECTS
Color mixing: Cyan: Magenta: Yellow: Dimmer: CMY
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Color(s): Protection rating:
Plastic, ABS
Anthracite gray (RAL 7016)
IP 44
INSTALLATION
The FiberSource CMY150 is an automated 150-watt colorchanging luminaire for illuminating fiber optic cables in indoor
and outdoor installations. It features seamless CMY color mixing
and full-range continuous dimming.
Indoor orientation: Outdoor orientation: Minimum distance to combustible materials: Minimum clearance around fan and air vents: Any
Horizontal
0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
0.2 m (0.7 ft.)
ELECTRICAL
AC power: Main fuse: 100/120/210/230/250 V, 50/60 Hz
5 AT (slow blow)
ARCHITECTURAL LIGHTING
Control options: DMX, stand-alone, synchronized (master/slave)
DMX channels: 7
Stand-alone trigger options: Internal timer and/or ambient light level
Stand-alone memory: 20 scenes
DMX address setting: MUM
Stand-alone and master/slave programming: MUM
Protocol: USITT DMX512/1990
Receiver: RS-485
THERMAL
Features
• 150 W metal halide lamp
• CMY color mixing system
• 0-100% intensity control
• Up to 800 fiber cables (1 mm)
• Weatherproof rating: IP44
• DMX, stand-alone, real time clock activation
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Maximum surface temperature, steady state, Ta=40° C: 70° C (158° F)
Cooling: Filtered forced air cooling system
Total heat dissipation (calculated, +/- 10%): 750 BTU/hr.
APPROVALS
US safety: Canadian safety: EU safety: EU EMC: UL 1598
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 250
EN 60598-2-17
EN 55015, EN 55103-1, EN 61547
INCLUDED ITEMS
Philips CDM-SA/R 150 lamp:
P/N 97010113
ACCESSORIES
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 398 mm (15.7 in.)
195 mm (7.7 in.)
197 mm (7.8 in.)
8 kg (17.6 lbs.)
Fiber adaptor, 350-800 pcs. (50 pcs. interval) Ø 1mm fiber, D= 38mm: P/N 91611034
Fiber adaptor, 75-350 pcs.: (25 pcs. interval) Ø 1 mm (0.04 in.) fiber, D= 30 mm (1.2 in.):
P/N 91611035
10 m (32.8 ft.) Light Fiber LF120HL, Ø 12 mm (0.5 in.):
P/N 91611070
20 m (65.6 ft.) Light Fiber LF120HL, Ø 12 mm (0.5 in.):
P/N 91611071
60 m (196.9 ft.) Light Fiber LF120HL, Ø 12 mm (0.5 in.):
P/N 91611072
ORDERING INFORMATION
FiberSource CMY 150, 230 V, 50 Hz:
FiberSource CMY 150, 120 V, 60 Hz:
P/N 90523000
P/N 90523100
LAMP
Type: Approved lamps: Socket: Control: 150 W metal halide
Philips CDM-SA/R 150
Separate connector for integral lamp wires
Automatic and/or remote on/off
93
• EC-10
• EC-20
• LC Plus Series
LED
VIDEO
•
•
•
•
•
•
VC-Grid
VC-Dot 1
VC-Dot 4
VC-Dot 9
VC-Feeder
P3 PowerPort 1500
• P3-100 System Controller
• P3-200 System Controller
• P3-PC System Controller
95
EC-10™
EC-20™
LC Plus Series™
Photometric Data
P3-PC™
P3-100™
P3-200™
Video Inputs
10,00mm
20,00mm
40,00mm
Composite Video
No
Yes, up to 720x576
No
LEDs
Multicolor SMD
Multicolor SMD
Single Color PTH
S-Video
No
Yes, up to 720x576
No
Brightness
3000nit
4000nit
3000nit
Component Video
No
Yes, up to 720x576
No
Refresh Rate
2250Hz
2250Hz
300Hz
DVI-D
No
Yes, up to 1280x1024
Yes, up to 1920x1080
Color Depth
16bit per color
16bit per color
14bit per color
SDI
No
No
Yes, up to 1920x1080
Calibration
Pixel-Level Brightness
and Color
Pixel-Level Brightness
and Color
Pixel-Level Brightness
and Color
On-Screen-Capture
Yes
No
No
Dimensions
Video Processing
Panel Size
480x720mm
480x720mm
1000x2000mm
De-Interlacing
No
Yes
Yes
Resolution per Panel
48x72pixels
24x36pixels
25x50pixels
Image Scaling
Yes
Yes
Yes
Pixels per Panel
3456
864
1250
Image Cropping
Yes
Yes
Yes
Pixels per SQM
10.000
2.500
625
Saturation Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
Transparency
0%
40%
60%
Sharpness Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
Brightness Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
Contrast Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
Lowlight Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
Gamma Curve Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
Color Temperature Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
P3
PC Hardware Dependant
Gigabit Ethernet
Gigabit Ethernet
Pixels
20.000
500.000
500.000
Expansion Stacking
No
Yes
Yes
Redundant Stacking
Yes
Yes
Yes
DMX Input
No
Yes
Yes
Kinesys Input
No
Yes
Yes
Status Webpage
No
Yes
Yes
PC Hardware Dependant
Rackmount 2U
Rackmount 2U
Monitor
PC Hardware Dependant
VGA
VGA
Keyboard
PC Hardware Dependant
USB
USB
Mouse
PC Hardware Dependant
USB
USB
Mechanical
Integrated Curvability
Stepless up 15 degrees
concave
Stepless up 20 degrees
concave or convex
None
Viewing Angle Horizontal
> 140 degrees
> 140 degrees
> 100 degrees
Viewing Angle Vertical
> 140 degrees
> 140 degrees
> 40 degrees
Weight per Panel
13,2kg
10,3kg
22,4kg
Weight per SQM
38,2kg
29,8kg
11,2kg
IP Rating
IP65
IP65
IP65
Processing
P3 System Controller
P3-100, P3-200 or P3-PC
P3-100, P3-200 or P3-PC
P3-100, P3-200 or P3-PC
LED VIDEO
Pixel Pitch
Output
Control Interfaces
Form-Factor
Dimensions
User Interface
97
EC-10™
Setup testing: Local test patterns
Video Processing
P3 System Controller: P3-100, P3-200 or P3-PC
P3 Signal Protocol
Signal type:
Gigabit Ethernet
Protocol: Proprietary Martin P3
Hot pluggable: Yes, electrically isolated at all connections
Cable type: Ethernet, CAT 5e or better
Cable length: Up to 100 m (328.1 ft.) between any 2 devices, extendable with Ethernet switch
Construction
Panel frames: LED modules per panel: Color: Protection rating: Features
• High contrast and brightness
(3000 Nit)
• Wide viewing angle (140°)
• High refresh rate (2250 Hz)
• Outstanding image quality
• IP65 protection
• Full compatibility with EC-20
• Fast and easy to assemble, no
tools, no cables
• Modular for easy serviceability
• P3 System Controller, easy
setup
Physical
480 mm (18.9 in.)
100 mm (3.9 in.)
720 mm (28.3 in.)
13,2 kg (29 lbs.)
480 mm (18.9 in.)
85 mm (3.3 in.)
120 mm (4.7 in.)
4.7 kg (10.4 lbs.)
960 mm (37.8 in.)
100 mm (3.9 in.)
130 mm (5.1 in.)
15.4 kg (34.0 lbs.)
1440 mm (56.7 in.)
100 mm (3.9 in.)
130 mm (5.1 in.)
23.1 kg (50.9 lbs.)
Control/User Interface
Device status: Orientation: Individually mounted panel any angle; suspended column vertical only
Max. suspended in one column: Max. sixteen EC Series panels
Panel interlocking: Quick-release mounting system
Connections
Power input to Header: 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) cable tail w/o power plug
P3 data input to Header: Accepts an Amphenol IP67-rated Ethernet cable connector
Panel power and data interconnection: Integrated connector system
Electrical
AC power: 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Power supply unit: Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
Main fuse: 2 x 3.15 AT
Peak power consumption (approx., at full intensity, full white): 330 W per panel
Typical power consumption (with typical video content): 110 W per panel
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1, EN 60529
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
ANSI/UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA 60950-1
Included Items
Included with EC-10 panel:
Included with 8-unit EC Series Flightcase:
1 x EC-10 video display panel
Safety and installation guide
Accessories
Specifications
EC-10 Video Display Panel
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: EC Series Single Header
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: EC Series Double Header
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: EC Series Triple Header
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: Installation
LED VIDEO
The EC-10 is a high performance, true 10 mm pixel pitch LED
display panel that teams with Martin’s EC-20 to form a fully
compatible EC family of LED displays that can be mixed and
matched for ultimate design creativity.
Featuring the same award-winning, lightweight and cable-free
design for rapid deployment, the EC-10 is 100% compatible
with the EC-20 in terms of color, setup, curving, control and
processing, even accessories, allowing for seamless, mixed
resolution visuals in one system.
Aluminum
18
Matt black
IP65, NEMA 4
Status indicator LED
EC Series Curving Installation Kit
(50 locking knobs, 25 ‘bananas’) in cardboard box: EC Series panel clamp: EC Series Input Connector:
EC Series Output Connector:
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connectors:
2.5 m (8.2 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connectors:
5 m (16.4 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data input cable with IP67-rated connectors:
30 m (98.4 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data input cable with IP67-rated connectors:
P/N 90354270
P/N 90354340
P/N 90354350
P/N 90354330
P/N 11840147
P/N 11840148
P/N 11840152
P/N 11840145
All EC Series and P3 System Controller Series user documentation is available for download free of charge
from the Product Support area at www.martin.com
Ordering Information
1 x EC-10 Video Panel, calibrated (supplied in separately ordered flightcase): P/N 90354320
Flightcase for 8 x EC Series panels (flightcase and panels are ordered separately):P/N 91515008
EC Series Single Header in Cardboard Box: P/N 90354240
EC Series Double Header (supplied in separately ordered flightcase): P/N 90354250
Flightcase for EC Series Double Header (order at same time as Header): P/N 91515006
EC Series Triple Header (supplied in separately ordered flightcase): P/N 90354260
Flightcase for EC Series Triple Header (order at same time as Header): P/N 91515007
EC-10 LED Block Right: P/N 90354300
EC-10 LED Block Left: P/N 90354310
Martin P3-100 System Controller: P/N 90721010
Martin P3-200 System Controller: P/N 90721020
Martin P3-PC License on One-Key USB stick: P/N 90721030
P3-PC License code:
P/N 39808028
99
EC-20™
P3 Signal Protocol
Signal type:
Gigabit Ethernet
Protocol: Proprietary Martin P3
Hot pluggable: Yes, electrically isolated at all connections
Cable type: Ethernet, CAT 5e or better
Cable length: Up to 100 m (328.1 ft.) between any 2 devices, extendable with Ethernet switch
Construction
Panel frames: LED modules per panel: Color: Protection rating: Aluminum
18
Matt black
IP65, NEMA 4
Installation
Orientation: Individually mounted panel any angle; suspended column vertical only
Max. suspended in one column: Max. sixteen EC Series panels
Panel interlocking: Quick-release mounting system
The EC-20 represents a new generation of indoor and outdoor
LED screen, combining low weight and creativity with state-ofthe-art image quality.
Connections
Power input to Header: 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) cable tail w/o power plug
P3 data input to Header: Accepts an Amphenol IP67-rated Ethernet cable connector
Panel power and data interconnection: Integrated connector system
Electrical
• Brightness: 4000 Nit
(calibrated)
• Pixel level color and intensity
calibration
• Outstanding image quality and
elegant, cable-free design
• 20 mm pixel pitch, semitransparent design
• Flexible - integrated curving
and full integration with
lighting control
• Lightweight, yet strong
• Fast to assemble, no tools, no
cables
• Powerful P3 system processor,
easy setup procedure
• Reliable, built to the highest
standards
Specifications
480 mm (18.9 in.)
100 mm (3.9 in.)
720 mm (28.3 in.)
10.3 kg (22.7 lbs.)
480 mm (18.9 in.)
85 mm (3.3 in.)
120 mm (4.7 in.)
4.7 kg (10.4 lbs.)
960 mm (37.8 in.)
100 mm (3.9 in.)
130 mm (5.1 in.)
15.4 kg (34.0 lbs.)
1440 mm (56.7 in.)
100 mm (3.9 in.)
130 mm (5.1 in.)
23.1 kg (50.9 lbs.)
Control/User Interface
Device status: Setup testing: Status indicator LED
Local test patterns
Video Processing
P3 System Controller: Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety:
Canadian safety: EN 60950-1, EN 60529
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Included Items
Included with EC-20 panel:
Included with 8-unit Panel Flightcase:
1 x EC-20 video display panel
EC-20 Safety and Installation Guide
Accessories
Physical
EC-20 Video Display Panel
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: EC Series Single Header
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: EC Series Double Header
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: EC Series Triple Header
Width: Depth: Height: Weight: AC power: 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Power supply unit: Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
Main fuse: 2 x 3.15 AT
Peak power consumption (approx., at full intensity, full white): 270 W per panel
Typical power consumption (with typical video content): 100 W per panel
LED VIDEO
Features
EC Series Curving Installation Kit
(50 locking knobs, 25 ‘bananas’) in cardboard box:
P/N 90354270
EC Series panel clamp:
P/N 90354340
EC Series Input Connector: P/N 90354350
EC Series Output Connector: P/N 90354330
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connectors: P/N 11840147
2.5 m (8.2 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connectors: P/N 11840148
5 m (16.4 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data input cable with IP67-rated connectors: P/N 11840152
30 m (98.4 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data input cable with IP67-rated connectors: P/N 11840145
All EC Series and P3 System Controller Series user documentation is available for download free of charge
from the Product Support area at www.martin.com
Ordering Information
1 x EC-20 Video Panel, calibrated (supplied in separately ordered flightcase): P/N 90354230
Flightcase, 8 x EC Series Panel Flightcase
(flightcase and panels are ordered separately): P/N 91515008
EC Series Single Header in Cardboard Box: P/N 90354240
EC Series Double Header (supplied in separately ordered flightcase): P/N 90354250
Flightcase for EC Series Double Header (order at same time as Header): P/N 91515006
EC Series Triple Header (supplied in separately ordered flightcase): P/N 90354260
Flightcase for EC Series Triple Header (order at same time as Header):
P/N 91515007
EC-20 LED Block Right: P/N 90354290
EC-20 LED Block Left: P/N 90354280
Martin P3-100 System Controller:
P/N 90721010
Martin P3-200 System Controller:
P/N 90721020
Martin P3-PC License on One-Key USB stick:
P/N 90721030
P3-PC License code: P/N 39808028
P3-100, P3-200 or P3-PC
101
LC Plus Series™
Installation
Orientation: Individually mounted panel any angle; stack or suspended chain
horizontal or vertical only
Max. suspended in one chain: Max. six 2140 panels hung vertically per single chain
Max. stacked: Max. seven 2140 panels standing vertically per single stack
Panel interlocking: Prolyte CCS6 conical coupler system
Connections
Power in/out: P3 data in/out: Ruggedized IP67-rated power connectors
Ruggedized IP67-rated RJ45 connectors
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Standby power: 200-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Integrated, auto-sensing multi-voltage
<35 W
Approvals
Features
• 40 mm pixel pitch
(seamless image at about 30m)
• Bright, 3000 Nit (calibrated)
• 60% transparency
• Pixel level color calibration for
superb color and brightness
uniformity
• Ethernet based signal
distribution, up to 50 panels in
daisy chain
• Designed for outdoor and
indoor use, IP65 protection
rating
• DMX controlled image
manipulation in real-time
Specifications
Physical
Height: Width: Depth: Weight: 2000 mm (78.7 in.)
1000 mm (39.4 in.)
152 mm (6.0 in.)
22.4 kg (49.4 lbs.)
Control/User Interface
Device status and addressing: Setup testing: Onboard control panel with LED display, status LEDs
Local test patterns
Video Processing
P3 System Controller: P3-100, P3-200 or P3-PC
P3 Signal ProtocoL
Signal type: Gigabit Ethernet
Protocol: Proprietary Martin P3
Hot pluggable: Yes, electrically isolated at all connections
Cable type: CAT 5e, UTP
Cable length: Up to 100 m (328.1 ft.) between any 2 devices, extendable with Ethernet switch
Latency between first and last panel: None
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety:
EN 60950-1, EN 60825-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Included Items
Included with cardboard box models:
4 x Prolyte CCS6 conical couplers: 8 x threaded spigots for LC Plus conical couplers: 8 mm (0.3 in.) hex key for threaded spigots:
5 m (16.4 ft.) power input cable with IP67-rated input connector
(single-phase power input): 5 m (16.4 ft.) power input cable with IP67-rated input connector
(2-phase power input): 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power throughput cable with IP67-rated connectors
(single-phase power systems): 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power throughput cable with IP67-rated connectors
(2-phase power systems): 2.5 m (8.2 ft.) Ethernet patch cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connectors:
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) Ethernet patch cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connectors:
P/N 21021150
P/N 08330127
P/N 50520619
P/N 11521030
P/N 11521034
LED VIDEO
LC Plus is a modular system of LED video panels designed
for the demanding rental and staging market as well as fixed
installations. A true IP65 protection rating, wide operating
temperature range and high level of brightness enable the LC
Plus to be used in most outdoor applications. A low weight and
high degree of transparency enable use in applications that
simply are not possible with conventional LED screens.
P/N 11521031
P/N 11521033
P/N 11840147
P/N 11840148
Accessories
Female conical coupler socket with hole for spigot: Half conical coupler with hole for spigot, length 44 mm (1.7 in.): Half conical coupler with hole for spigot, length 63 mm (2.5 in.): Half conical coupler without hole for spigot, length 44 mm (1.7 in.): 30 m (98.4 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data input cable
with IP67 connector for LC Plus: 5 m (16.4 ft.) Ethernet CAT 5e data input cable with IP67-rated connectors:
Power Cable, US, Daisychain, 2,5M Power Cable, EU, Daisychain, 2,5M Power Cable, EU, Daisychain, 5M Power Cable, US, Daisychain, 5M Four-unit flightcase for 4 x LC Plus 2140 video panels: P/N 21021151
P/N 21021152
P/N 21021153
P/N 26820300
P/N 11840145
P/N 11840152
P/N 11521043
P/N 11521044
P/N 11521045
P/N 11521046 P/N 91510120
All LC Plus Series and P3 System Controller Series user documentation is available free of charge from the
Product Support area at www.martin.com
Ordering Information
LC Plus 2140 panel, in flightcase: LC Plus 2140 panel, in cardboard box: Martin P3-100 System Controller: Martin P3-200 System Controller: Martin P3-PC License on One-Key USB stick: P3-PC License code: P/N 90354101
P/N 90354102
P/N 90721010
P/N 90721020
P/N 90721030
P/N 39808028
Construction
Panel frames: LED tubes: Transparency through panel (unmasked area): Protection rating: Aluminum
UV-resistant acrylic
>60%
IP65, NEMA 4
103
VC-Grid™
Control and Programming
Control options: Martin P3 System Controller via Martin P3 PowerPort 1500 and/or DMX
Protocol detection: Automatic
Control modes: Calibrated and raw, pixel and module
192 (pixel mode) or 3 (module mode)
DMX channels (RGB): DMX channels (WW, MW and CW): 64 (pixel mode) or 1 (module mode)
Setting and addressing: P3 System controller or RDM-compliant controller
Control resolution: 16-bit (P3) or 8-bit (DMX) control of each color
Color and intensity calibration: Pixel-level
DMX compliance: USITT DMX512-A
ANSI/ESTA E1.20
RDM compliance: Firmware update: Via P3 System Controller
Optics
Minimum LED lifetime: 50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Features
• 64 individually controllable
pixels
• 4000 Nits of brightness
(calibrated mode)
• High-quality 16-bit per color
image processing technology
• Pixel-level brightness and color
calibration for optimal image
quality
• P3/DMX controllable
(automatic protocol detection)
• Intuitive mapping and
addressing via P3 System
Controller
• Combined power/data input
(single cable for power and
data input)
• Combined power/data thru (to
daisy-chain multiple VC-Grids)
• Available in RGB, cool white,
medium white and warm white
• Supported by integrated
power and data processor
(P3 PowerPort 1500) and
simple cabling system
• Custom designs available
on request (pixel pitch and
module dimensions)
Device status: Device test and reset: Multi-color visual indication
Pushbutton to call up local test patterns and reset device
Video Processing
Brightness control
Gamma correction and control
Color temperature control
Calibration processing
Synchronization
Photometric Data
Pixels per module: Color temperature, WW: Color temperature, MW: Color temperature, CW: Luminous intensity, RGB, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, RGB, raw mode: Luminous intensity, WW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, WW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, MW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, MW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, CW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, CW, raw mode: Viewing angle: 64
2700 K
4000 K
6500 K
4000 Nit
5000 Nit
8 000 Nit
10 000 Nit
8 000 Nit
10 000 Nit
8 000 Nit
10 000 Nit
120° x 120°
Construction
Base: Transparency through module (unmasked area): Protection rating:
RoHS compliant
Black FR4 circuit board
37%
IP20
Installation
Orientation: Any
12
Maximum number of VC-Grid 8x8 25 modules per daisy-chain: Mounting: Mounting holes in module, mounting accessories will be available
Connections
Power & data input: Power & data thru: Specifications
4-pin Molex connector
4-pin Molex connector
Electrical
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Control/User Interface
LED VIDEO
The VC-Grid is a small, 200 x 200 mm LED video module with
a 25 mm pixel pitch. Useful in creating customized LED video
solutions with maximum artistic flexibility and a minimum of
effort, the VC-Grid’s compact size makes it extremely suitable
for integration into stage designs, set elements, creative
ceilings, lobbies and much more. Used with or without a front
diffuser, multiple VC-Grids can be combined in a countless
variety of ways for ultimate design freedom. A combined power/
data cable allows VC-Grids to be daisy-chained for easy setup
and less cabling.
185 mm (7.3 in.)
185 mm (7.3 in.)
18 mm (0.7 in.)
140 g (4.9 oz.)
Nominal input voltage: 48 VDC from Martin P3 PowerPort 1500
or generic PSU
Typical Power and Current
Power consumption per module: 25 W at full white
105
VC-Grid™
VC-Dot 1™
Specifications
Thermal
Cooling: Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): Convection
45° C (113° F)
-20° C (-4° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
ANSI/UL 60950-1
CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Accessories
P/N 11840158
P/N 11840159
P/N 11840171
P/N 11840160
P/N 11840161
P/N 11840162
P/N 11840163
P/N 11840157
Related Items
Martin P3 PowerPort 1500: Martin P3-100 System Controller: Martin P3-200 System Controller: Martin P3-PC System Controller: P/N 90721040
P/N 90721010
P/N 90721020
P/N 90721030
Ordering Information
VC-Grid RGB, 8x8: VC-Grid WW, 8x8: VC-Grid MW, 8x8: VC-Grid CW 8x8:
P/N 90357010
P/N 90357000
P/N 90357030
P/N 90357020
VC-Dot 1 is a lightweight string of individually controllable,
bright Dots useful in creating customized LED video solutions
with maximum artistic flexibility and a minimum of effort. Fully
customizable and controllable via the award-winning P3 System
Controller™ family and/or DMX512, it is a perfect solution for
integrating LED video technology into façades, stage designs,
ceilings or any other structure, indoors or out.
Mapping video onto VC-Dots goes quickly and intuitively via
the P3 System Controller. No need for complex setups and
time-consuming addressing. VC-Dot 1 contains one LED and
is available in an RGB color mixing version or cool, medium, or
warm white single-color versions.
LED VIDEO
Hybrid (Power & Data) Adapter, 4-pin XLR to PCB, 0.25 m (0.8 ft.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Adapter, PCB to 4-pin XLR, 0.25 m (0.8 ft.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Adapter, 5-pin XLR
+ power to 4-pin XLR, 0.25 m (0.8 ft.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, PCB to PCB, 200 mm (7.9 in.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, PCB to PCB, 400 mm (15.7 in.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, PCB to PCB, 600 mm (23.6 in.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, PCB to PCB, 800 mm (31.5 in.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, PCB to PCB, 1000 mm (39.4 in.): Features
• Can assume any form for
creative freedom
• Individually controllable Dots
• Bright at 3cd per Dot
(raw mode)
• Maximum 100 Dots per string
• Each Dot features calibrated
brightness and colors
• Various Dot spacings available
• Customizable string length
• P3 or DMX controllable
• Intuitive mapping and
addressing via P3 System
Controller family
• Efficient and long-lasting
• IP67 rated for permanent
outdoor or indoor use
• Perfect for façade or stage
integration
• Supported by integrated power
and data processor
(P3 PowerPort 1500™) and
simple cabling system
Specifications
Physical
Pixel dimensions: Pixel dimensions with dome: Max. pixels per string: Minimum pixel spacing (pitch): Maximum pixel spacing (pitch): Maximum lead-in cable length: Weight: 20 mm (0.8 in.) x 22 mm (0.9 in.) x 11 mm (0.4 in.)
20 mm (0.8 in.) x 22 mm (0.9 in.) x 21 mm (0.8 in.)
100
50 mm (2.0 in.)
1000 mm (39.4 in.)
2000 mm (78.7 in.)
1.3 kg (2.9 lbs.) for 100 Dots, 100 mm (3.9 in.) spacing,
with 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in cable and connector
107
VC-Dot 1™
VC-Dot 1™
One pixel = one Dot
Accessories
Control and Programming
Control options: DMX channels: Control modes: Setting and addressing: Control resolution: Color and intensity calibration: DMX compliance: RDM compliance: Martin P3 System controller and/or DMX
3 per independently controlled Dot or per entire string
Calibrated and raw
P3 System controller or RDM-compliant controller
16-bit (P3) or 8-bit (DMX) control of each color
Dot-level
USITT DMX512-A
ANSI/ESTA E1.2
Optics
Minimum LED lifetime: 50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Photometric Data
One RGB, WW, MW or CW LED
2700 K
4000 K
6500 K
2.5 cd
3 cd
4 cd
5 cd
4 cd
5 cd
4 cd
5 cd
120° x 120°
180° x 180°
P/N 90357180
P/N 90357210
Related Items
Martin VC-Feeder: Martin P3 PowerPort 1500: Martin P3-100 System Controller: Martin P3-200 System Controller: Martin P3-PC System Controller: P/N 90357040
P/N 90721040
P/N 90721010
P/N 90721020
P/N 90721030
Ordering Information
VC-Dot 1 RGB, 100 mm (3.9 in.) pitch, 100 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in:
VC-Dot 1 WW, 100 mm (3.9 in.) pitch, 100 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in:
VC-Dot 1 MW, 100 mm (3.9 in.) pitch, 100 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in:
VC-Dot 1 CW, 100 mm (3.9 in.) pitch, 100 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in:
P/N 90357060
P/N 90357090
P/N 90357080
P/N 90357070
LED VIDEO
Light source: Color temperature, WW: Color temperature, MW: Color temperature, CW:
Luminous intensity, RGB, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, RGB, raw mode: Luminous intensity, WW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, WW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, MW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, MW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, CW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, CW, raw mode: Viewing angle: Viewing angle with dome: Set of ten VC-Dot 1 Diffuser Domes: Set of ten VC-Dot 1 Mounting Clips: Construction
Dot: Diffuser dome: Mounting clip:
Interconnecting cable: String input connector: Protection rating: RoHS compliant
Clear polycarbonate, clear silicone filled
White translucent polycarbonate
White polycarbonate
6 x AWG20, black
8-pin M12 IP67
IP65
Electrical
Operating voltage:
Power and data converter:
15 VDC
Martin VC-Feeder (IP65)
Typical Power and Current
Power consumption per pixel:
1 W at full white
Thermal
Cooling:
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.):
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): Convection
55° C (131° F)
-20° C (-4° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
109
VC-Dot 4™
DMX channels: Control modes: Setting and addressing: Control resolution: Color and intensity calibration: DMX compliance: RDM compliance: 3 per independently controlled Dot or per entire string
Calibrated and raw
P3 System controller or RDM-compliant controller
16-bit (P3) or 8-bit (DMX) control of each color
Dot-level
USITT DMX512-A
ANSI/ESTA E1.20
Optics
Minimum LED lifetime: 50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Photometric Data
Features
• Can assume any form for
creative freedom
• Individually controllable Dots
• Bright at 9cd per Dot (raw
mode)
• Maximum 64 Dots per string
• Each Dot features calibrated
brightness and colors
• Various Dot spacings available
• Customizable string length
• P3 or DMX controllable
• Intuitive mapping and
addressing via P3 System
Controller family
• Efficient and long-lasting
• IP66 rated for permanent
outdoor or indoor use
• Perfect for façade or stage
integration
• Supported by integrated power
and data processor
(P3 PowerPort 1500™) and
simple cabling system
Dot: Diffuser dome:
Mounting clip: Interconnecting cable: String input connector: Protection rating: RoHS compliant
Clear polycarbonate, clear silicone filled
White translucent polycarbonate
White polycarbonate
6 x AWG20, black
8-pin M12 IP67
IP66
Electrical
Operating voltage: Power and data converter: 15 VDC
Martin VC-Feeder (IP65)
Typical Power and Current
Power consumption per pixel: 1.5 W at full white
Thermal
Cooling: Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): Convection
55° C (131° F)
-20° C (-4° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
ANSI/UL 60950-1
CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Set of ten VC-Dot 4 Diffuser Domes: Set of ten VC-Dot 4 Mounting Clips: Physical
30 mm (1.2 in.) x 30 mm (1.2 in.) x 13 mm (0.5 in.)
30 mm (1.2 in.) x 30 mm (1.2 in.) x 27 mm (1.1 in.)
64
50 mm (2.0 in.)
2000 mm (78.7 in.)
2000 mm (78.7 in.)
1.8 kg (4.0 lbs.) for 64 Dots, 200 mm (7.9 in.) spacing,
with 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in cable and connector
One pixel = one Dot
Control and Programming
Control options: Construction
Accessories
Specifications
Pixel dimensions: Pixel dimensions with dome: Max. pixels per string: Minimum pixel spacing (pitch): Maximum pixel spacing (pitch): Maximum lead-in cable length: Weight: Four RGB, WW, MW or CW LEDs
2700 K
4000 K
6500 K
7.5 cd
9 cd
12 cd
15 cd
12 cd
15 cd
12 cd
15 cd
120° x 120°
180° x 180°
LED VIDEO
VC-Dot 4 is a lightweight string of individually controllable,
bright Dots useful in creating customized LED video solutions
with maximum artistic flexibility and a minimum of effort. Fully
customizable and controllable via the award-winning P3 System
Controller™ family and/or DMX512, it is a perfect solution for
integrating LED video technology into façades, stage designs,
ceilings or any other structure, indoors or out.
Mapping video onto VC-Dots goes quickly and intuitively via
the P3 System Controller. No need for complex setups and timeconsuming addressing. VC-Dot 4 contains four LEDs and is
available in an RGB color mixing version or cool, medium, or
warm white single-color versions.
Light source: Color temperature, WW: Color temperature, MW: Color temperature, CW: Luminous intensity, RGB, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, RGB, raw mode: Luminous intensity, WW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, WW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, MW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, MW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, CW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, CW, raw mode: Viewing angle: Viewing angle with dome: Martin P3 System controller and/or DMX
P/N 90357190
P/N 90357220
Related Items
Martin VC-Feeder: Martin P3 PowerPort 1500: Martin P3-100 System Controller: Martin P3-200 System Controller: Martin P3-PC System Controller: P/N 90357040
P/N 90721040
P/N 90721010
P/N 90721020
P/N 90721030
Ordering Information
VC-Dot 4 RGB, 200 mm (7.9 in.) pitch, 64 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in:
VC-Dot 4 WW, 200 mm (7.9 in.) pitch, 64 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in: VC-Dot 4 MW, 200 mm (7.9 in.) pitch, 64 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in: VC-Dot 4 CW, 200 mm (7.9 in.) pitch, 64 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in: P/N 90357100
P/N 90357130
P/N 90357120
P/N 90357110
111
VC-Dot 9™
Control modes: Setting and addressing: Control resolution: Color and intensity calibration: DMX compliance: RDM compliance: Calibrated and raw
P3 System controller or RDM-compliant controller
16-bit (P3) or 8-bit (DMX) control of each color
Dot-level
USITT DMX512-A
ANSI/ESTA E1.20
Optics
Minimum LED lifetime: 50 000 hours (to >70% luminous output)*
*Manufacturer´s figure obtained under manufacturer´s test conditions
Photometric
Features
• Can assume any form for
creative freedom
• Individually controllable Dots
• Bright at 27cd per Dot (raw
mode)
• Maximum 36 Dots per string
• Each Dot features calibrated
brightness and colors
• Various Dot spacings available
• Customizable string length
• P3 or DMX controllable
• Intuitive mapping and
addressing via P3 System
Controller family
• Efficient and long-lasting
• IP66 rated for permanent
outdoor or indoor use
• Perfect for façade or stage
integration
• Supported by integrated
power and data processor
(P3 PowerPort 1500™) and
simple cabling system
Dot: Diffuser dome: Mounting clip: Interconnecting cable: String input connector: Protection rating: RoHS compliant
Clear polycarbonate, clear silicone filled
White translucent polycarbonate
White polycarbonate
6 x AWG20, black
8-pin M12 IP67
IP66
Electrical
Operating voltage: Power and data converter: 15 VDC
Martin VC-Feeder (IP65)
Typical Power and Current
Power consumption per pixel: 3 W at full white
Thermal
Cooling: Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): Convection
55° C (131° F)
-20° C (-4° F)
Approvals
EU safety: US EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
ANSI/UL 60950-1
CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Set of ten VC-Dot 9 Diffuser Domes: Set of ten VC-Dot 9 Mounting Clips: Physical
40 mm (1.6 in.) x 40 mm (1.6 in.) x 13 mm (0.5 in.)
40 mm (1.6 in.) x 40 mm (1.6 in.) x 32 mm (1.3 in.)
36
50 mm (2.0 in.)
2000 mm (78.7 in.)
2000 mm (78.7 in.)
1.8 kg (4.0 lbs.) for 36 Dots, 400 mm (15.7 in.) spacing,
with 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in cable and connector
One pixel = one Dot
Control and Programming
Control options:
DMX channels: Construction
Accessories
Specifications
Pixel dimensions: Pixel dimensions with dome: Max. pixels per string: Minimum pixel spacing (pitch): Maximum pixel spacing (pitch): Maximum lead-in cable length: Weight: Nine RGB, WW, MW or CW LEDs
2700 K
4000 K
6500 K
22.5 cd
cd
36 cd
45 cd
36 cd
45 cd
36 cd
45 cd
120° x 120°
180° x 180°
LED VIDEO
VC-Dot 9 is a lightweight string of individually controllable,
bright Dots useful in creating customized LED video solutions
with maximum artistic flexibility and a minimum of effort. Fully
customizable and controllable via the award-winning P3 System
Controller™ family and/or DMX512, it is a perfect solution for
integrating LED video technology into façades, stage designs,
ceilings or any other structure, indoors or out.
Mapping video onto VC-Dots goes quickly and intuitively via
the P3 System Controller. No need for complex setups and timeconsuming addressing. VC-Dot 9 contains nine LEDs and is
available in an RGB color mixing version or cool, medium, or
warm white single-color versions.
Data Light source: Color temperature, WW: Color temperature, MW: Color temperature, CW: Luminous intensity, RGB, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, RGB, raw mode: Luminous intensity, WW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, WW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, MW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, MW, raw mode: Luminous intensity, CW, calibrated mode: Luminous intensity, CW, raw mode: Viewing angle: Viewing angle with dome: Martin P3 System controller and/or DMX
3 per independently controlled Dot or per entire string
P/N 90357200
P/N 90357170
Related Items
Martin VC-Feeder: Martin P3 PowerPort 1500: Martin P3-100 System Controller: Martin P3-200 System Controller: Martin P3-PC System Controller: P/N 90357040
P/N 90721040
P/N 90721010
P/N 90721020
P/N 90721030
Ordering Information
VC-Dot 9 RGB, 400 mm (15.7 in.) pitch, 36 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in: VC-Dot 9 WW, 400 mm (15.7 in.) pitch, 36 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in: VC-Dot 9 MW, 400 mm (15.7 in.) pitch, 36 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in: VC-Dot 9 CW, 400 mm (15.7 in.) pitch, 36 pcs., 2 m (6.6 ft.) lead-in: P/N 90357140
P/N 90357050
P/N 90357160
P/N 90357150
113
VC-Feeder™
Video Processing
Brightness control
Gamma correction and control
Color temperature control
Calibration processing
Synchronization
Construction
Housing: Protection rating: RoHS compliant
Extruded aluminum
IP65
Installation
Orientation: Surface mounting: Truss mounting: Any
Two M6 mounting slots
M12 mounting hole for standard rigging clamp
Connections
Features
• High-quality, 16-bit-per-color
image processing technology
• IP65 rated for permanent
outdoor or indoor use
• P3/DMX controllable
(automatic protocol detection)
• Intuitive mapping and
addressing via P3 System
Controller family
• Hybrid power + data input
(single cable for power and
data input)
• Hybrid power + data thru
(to daisy-chain multiple
VC-Feeders)
• Hybrid power + data output
(to a string of VC-Dots)
• Surface- and truss-mountable
Specifications
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 164 mm (6.5 in.) including mounting ears
68 mm (2.7 in.)
36 mm (1.4 in.)
590 g (20.8 oz.)
Control and Programming
Control options: Martin P3 System Controller via Martin P3 PowerPort 1500 and/or DMX
Protocol detection: Automatic
Product detection: Automatic
Control modes: Adapts to detected product
DMX channels: Adapts to detected product
Setting and addressing: P3 System controller or RDM-compliant controller
DMX compliance: USITT DMX512-A
RDM compliance: ANSI/ESTA E1.20
Firmware update: Via P3 System Controller
Control/User Interface
Device status: Device test and reset: Multicolor status LED
Pushbutton to call up local test patterns and reset device
Power & data input: Power & data thru: Power & data output: 6-pin custom IP65-rated
6-pin custom IP65-rated
8-pin custom IP65-rated
Electrical
Nominal input voltage:
Output voltage: Maximum total power consumption: 48 VDC from Martin P3 PowerPort 1500 or
Martin DMX PowerPort 375
15 VDC
120 W
Thermal
Cooling: Convection
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 55° C (131° F)
-20° C (-4° F)
LED VIDEO
The VC-Feeder is a smart, multi-protocol driver box for the VCDot series. A compact design and IP65 rating make it perfectly
suited for installation close to a string of VC-Dots. The VCFeeder provides the string with clean, regulated power, even if
the power supply is located far away. Compatibility with the P3
System Controller™ (via the P3 PowerPort 1500™) gives it highquality image processing capabilities with extremely easy setup
and configuration.
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
ANSI/UL 60950-1
CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Accessories
Hybrid input adapter cable, 4-pin male
XLR to 6-pin female IP65, 0.25 m (0.8 ft.):
Hybrid Power+Data Adapter XLR5+Power-IP65 0.25m
Hybrid output adapter cable, 6-pin male IP65
to 4-pin female XLR, 0.25 m (0.8 ft.): Hybrid extension cable, IP65 to IP65, 1 m (3.3 ft.): Hybrid extension cable, IP65 to IP65, 2.5 m (8.2 ft.): Hybrid extension cable, IP65 to IP65, 5 m (16.4 ft.): Hybrid extension cable, IP65 to IP65, 10 m (32.8 ft.): Hybrid extension cable, IP65 to IP65, 25 m (82.0 ft.): P/N 11840165
P/N 11840174
P/N 11840166
P/N 11840167
P/N 11840168
P/N 11840169
P/N 11840170
P/N 11840164
Hybrid cables carry power and data over separate conductors IP67 connectors are custom items
G-clamp: Half-coupler clamp: Quick trigger clamp: Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 91602003
P/N 91602005
P/N 91602007
P/N 91604003
Related Items
Martin VC-Dot 1
Martin VC-Dot 4
Martin VC-Dot 9
Martin P3 PowerPort 1500: Martin P3-100 System Controller: Martin P3-200 System Controller: Martin P3-PC System Controller: P/N 90721040
P/N 90721010
P/N 90721020
P/N 90721030
Ordering Information
VC-Feeder: P/N 90357040
115
P3 PowerPort 1500™
System integration
VC-Dot Series via VC-Feeder
VC-Grid Series
Construction
Housing: Color: Protection rating: Steel and aluminum
Matt black
IP20
Installation
Mounting: 19-inch rackmount, wall mount, flown from rigging clamps
Connections Power input: Neutrik PowerCon
P3 data in/out: Two Neutrik Ethercon RJ-45 sockets
Combined power & data out: Four 4-pin female XLR sockets (hybrid power & data cable)
Electrical
Features
• P3 image processing
technology
• Set-up and addressing via
P3 System Controller family
• P3 input and thru to allow
daisy-chaining
• 4 hybrid power/data output
ports
• Wall-, truss- and rackmountable
• Can be located up to 50 m
away from the creative LED
video products
Specifications
Physical
Depth: Width: Height (rackmount 2U):
Weight: 335 mm (13.2 in.)
482 mm (19.0 in.)
88 mm (3.5 in.)
10 kg (22.0 lbs.)
Control and Programming
Addressing and status: Mapping: Firmware update: Via P3 System Controller
Via P3 System Controller
Via P3 System Controller
Control/User Interface
Device status: Power output status: Data output status: Device test and reset: Multicolor status LED
Four LEDs
Four LEDs
Pushbutton to call up local test patterns and reset device
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 H
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
10 AT (slow blow) x 4
1540 W, full load at full intensity
Thermal
Cooling: Filtered forced air (temperature-regulated, low noise)
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 45° C (113° F)
Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): -20° C (-4° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EN 60950
EU EMC: EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 55022, EN 55024,
EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
US safety: ANSI/UL 60950-1
Canadian safety: CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Included Items Mounting brackets incl. screws
Safety wire attachment eyelet
LED VIDEO
The P3 PowerPort 1500 is an integrated power and data
processor for Martin’s range of creative LED video products,
including the VC-Dots™ and VC-Grids™. When driven by one
of Martin’s award-winning P3 System Controllers™, it powers
the connected products with high-quality image processing
capabilities and extremely easy setup and configuration.
AC power: Power supply units: Main fuses: Typical total power consumption: Accessories
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA
power input connector, cable mount, blue:
3 m (9.8 ft.) power cable, 12 AWG, SJT,
with PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector: 2 m (6.6 ft.) shielded CAT 5e Ethercon cable, ferrite cores,
RJ45 connectors in Neutrik shells: Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, 4-pin XLR, 1 m (3.3 ft.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, 4-pin XLR, 2.5 m (8.2 ft.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, 4-pin XLR, 5 m (16.4 ft.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, 4-pin XLR, 10 m (32.8 ft.): Hybrid (Power & Data) Cable, 4-pin XLR, 25 m (82.0 ft.): G-clamp: Half-coupler clamp: Quick trigger clamp: Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 05342804
P/N 11541503
P/N 11840144
P/N 11821016
P/N 11821017
P/N 11821018
P/N 11821019
P/N 11821015
P/N 91602003
P/N 91602005
P/N 91602007
P/N 91604003
Related Items
Martin P3-100 System Controller: Martin P3-200 System Controller: Martin P3-PC System Controller: P/N 90721010
P/N 90721020
P/N 90721030
Spare Parts
10 AT main fuse: P/N 05021029
Ordering Information
Martin P3 PowerPort 1500: P/N 90721040
P3 Signal Protocol
Signal type: Gigabit Ethernet
Protocol: Proprietary Martin P3
Hot pluggable: Yes, electrically isolated at all connections
Cable type: Ethernet, CAT 5e or better
Cable length: Up to 100 m (328.1 ft.) between any 2 devices, extendable with Ethernet switch
117
P3-100 System Controller™
Analog video input: Frame synchronization to analog input signal
Image rotation
Scaling
De-interlacing
Gamma curve selection and adjustment
Real-time panel content remapping
Real-time color temperature control
Composite, component and S-video
P3 Signal Protocol
The P3-100 System Controller is a robust video signal processing
and distribution unit that allows video to join with lighting
and scenic technologies for true visual integration. Based
on embedded Linux and solid state storage, just one P3-100
Controller can handle up to 500,000 pixels scaled to any size.
• Built in scaling and
de-interlacing
• Supports both DVI
(up to SXGA@75Hz) as well
as analog video signals
(CVBS, S-Video & Component)
• Allows key parameters
including brightness and image
mapping to be manipulated in
real time using DMX512
Gigabit Ethernet
Proprietary Martin P3
Yes, electrically isolated at all connections
Cat 5e
Up to 100 m (328.1 ft.) between any 2 devices,
extendable with Ethernet switch
50, extendable with Ethernet switch
None
Construction
Housing: Color: Protection rating: Steel and aluminum
Matt black
IP20
Installation
• Built-in GUI (Graphical User
Interface) including easy setup
wizard
• Real time visualization of the
video mapping within the GUI
(Graphical user interface)
• Configurations can be
conveniently exported onto a
USB stick
• LED panels communicate with
the P3-100 Controller to report
any problems
Mounting: 19-inch rackmount (2U)
Connections
Power input:
P3 data in/out: Kinesys and webpage in/out: DVI video in: Analog video in: DMX in: Peripherals and USB memory devices: Analog monitor: Serial data (available for future options): IEC socket, power cables supplied
RJ-45 socket
RJ-45 socket
DVI-D (DVI-I connector provided)
BNC
5-pin locking XLR
4 x USB ports
DD15
RS-232 via DB9 connector
LED VIDEO
Features
Signal type: Protocol: Hot pluggable: Cable type: Cable length: Max. number of panels per line: Latency between first and last panel: Electrical
AC power:
Power supply unit: Main fuse: 115-250 V, 47-63 Hz
Integrated, universal multi-voltage
1 A, T (slow blow)
Thermal
Cooling: Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): Specifications
Physical
Depth: Width: Height (rackmount 2U): Weight: 380 mm (15.0 in.)
482 mm (19.0 in.)
90 mm (3.5 in.)
7.7 kg (17.0 lbs.)
Control/User Interface
Forced air
50° C (122° F)
0° C (32° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
User interface: SXGA (1280 x 1024) or better monitor, keyboard, mouse
Device status:
Status indicator LEDs
DMX512 remotely controllable parameters
Global: Freeze frame, blackout, test patterns, color temperature,
video input selection and settings preset recall
Panel/panel group: Intensity, RGB adjustment, X-Y video image position, rotation, grouping
Kinesys remotely controllable parameters
Panel/panel group: X-Y video image position, rotation
Included Items
Video Processing
Martin P3-100 System Controller: EU-type power cable with Schuko connector
US-type power cable
UK-type power cable
30 m (98.4 ft.) Ethernet data cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connector: P/N 11840145
Installation and safety manual: P/N 35000218
User documentation CD: P/N 35005008
Ordering Information
P/N 90721010
Processor capacity: 500 000 pixels (expandable by adding P3-100s)
Output resolution: Any within 500 K pixel limit (expandable by adding P3-100s)
System latency DVI: 1 frame
System latency analog progressive: 1 frame
System latency analog interlaced: 3 frames
DVI video input: Up to 1280 x 1024, 50/60/75 Hz
119
P3-200 System Controller™
Image rotation
Scaling
De-interlacing
Gamma curve selection and adjustment
Real-time panel content remapping
Real-time color temperature control
P3 Signal Protocol
Features
• SD-SDI, HD-SDI and 3G-SDI
video inputs for use with
professional broadcast
equipment
• DVI-D video input
• Supports input resolutions up
to full HD (1920x1080)
• Software and showfile
compatible with P3-100 System
Controller
• The most user-friendly user
interface in LED video
• Works with all Martin LED
display systems
Construction
Housing: Color: Protection rating: Steel and aluminum
Matt black
IP20
Installation
Mounting: 19-inch rackmount (2U)
Connections
Power input: P3 data in/out: Kinesys and webpage in/out: DVI video in: SDI video in: SDI video thru: DMX in: Peripherals and USB memory devices: User interface monitor: Serial data (available for future options): IEC socket, power cables supplied
RJ-45 socket
RJ-45 socket
DVI-D (DVI-I connector provided)
BNC
BNC
5-pin locking XLR
4 x USB ports
VGA/DD15
RS-232 via DB9 connector
LED VIDEO
The P3-200 System Controller combines all the celebrated
features of the P3-100 yet adds SD-SDI, HD-SDI and 3G-SDI
input capability for optimized use in TV/Broadcast environments.
It retains all the advantages of the P3-100 System Controller like
built-in scaling and de-interlacing, multiple video protocol and
resolution support, built-in graphical user interface, direct DMX
control of brightness, color, pixelmapping and more.
Signal type: Gigabit Ethernet
Protocol: Proprietary Martin P3
Hot pluggable: Yes, electrically isolated at all connections
Cable type: Ethernet, CAT 5e or better
Cable length: Up to 100 m (328.1 ft.) between any 2 devices, extendable with Ethernet switch
Max. number of panels per line: 50, extendable with Ethernet switch
Latency between first and last panel: None
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: 115-250 V, 47-63 Hz
Integrated, universal multi-voltage
1 A, T (slow blow)
Thermal
Cooling: Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): Specifications
Physical
Depth: Width: Height (rackmount 2U): Weight: 380 mm (15.0 in.)
482 mm (19.0 in.)
90 mm (3.5 in.)
7.7 kg (17.0 lbs.)
Control/User Interface
User interface: SXGA (1280 x 1024) or better monitor, keyboard, mouse
Device status: Status indicator LEDs
DMX512 remotely controllable parameters
Global: Freeze frame, blackout, test patterns, color temperature,
video input selection and settings preset recall
Panel/panel group: Intensity, RGB adjustment, X-Y video image position, rotation, grouping
Kinesys remotely controllable parameters
Panel/panel group: X-Y video image position, rotation
Forced air
50° C (122° F)
0° C (32° F)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1
Included Items
EU-type power cable with Schuko connector
US-type power cable
UK-type power cable
30 m (98.4 ft.) Ethernet data cable with IP67-rated RJ-45 connector: P/N 11840145
Ordering Information
Martin P3-200 System Controller: P/N 90721020
Video Processing
Processor capacity: 500 000 pixels (expandable by adding P3-200s)
Output resolution: Any within 500 K pixel limit (expandable by adding P3-100s)
Processing depth: 16 bit per color
System latency, DVI: 1 frame
System latency, SDI progressive: 1 frame
System latency, SDI interlaced: 3 frames
DVI video input: Up to 1920 x 1080, 50/60/75 Hz
SDI video input: SD-SDI, HD-SDI and 3G-SDI (Level A only)
121
P3-PC System Controller™
Video Processing
Processor capacity: Output resolution: Processing depth: System latency: Latency between first and last panel: Video input: Image rotation
Scaling
Gamma curve selection and adjustment
Real-time panel content remapping
Real-time color temperature control
20 000 pixels
Any within 20 K pixel limit
16 bit per color
1 frame
None
On-screen capture window
P3 Signal Protocol
The P3-PC works as a PC-based P3 System Controller for
smaller Martin LED display setups up to 20000 pixels; as an
off-line editor for the P3-100 and P3-200 System Controllers to
preprogram shows anywhere on a PC; and as a tool for firmware
uploads and addressing/testing of Martin LED displays.
Signal type: Gigabit Ethernet
Protocol: Proprietary Martin P3
Hot pluggable: Yes, electrically isolated at all connections
Cable type: Ethernet, CAT 5e or better
Cable length: Up to 100 m (328.1 ft.) between any 2 devices, extendable with Ethernet switch
Max. number of panels per line: 50, extendable with Ethernet switch
Installation
LED VIDEO
Any standard PC running Windows Vista, XP or 7
(requires Martin One-Key USB stick with P3-PC License)
Connections
P3 signal output to panels via PC network port
Features
• Based on award-winning
P3 System Controller user
interface
• Plays video on screens up to
20000 pixels
• Configurations can be
conveniently imported/
exported onto a USB stick
Included Items
• Showfile-compatible with
P3-100 and P3-200 System
Controllers
• Compatible with any standard
PC running Windows
• Free download from Martin
website
Martin One Key loaded with P3-PC License
Ordering Information
Martin P3-PC License on One-Key USB stick: P3-PC License code: P/N 90721030
P/N 39808028
Specifications
Control/User Interface
PC hardware dependent
No remotely controllable parameters
Minimum System Requirements
Windows XP, Vista and Windows 7 32/64 bit
Intel Core processor
1024 MB RAM (3 GB recommended)
100 MB available hard disk space
Display with 1024 x 768 resolution
USB 1.1 (or higher) port for Martin One-Key
Full administrator rights on PC
100/1000 Ethernet port for P3 output
123
CONTROL
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
M1
M2GO
M2PC
M-PC
iOS MAXRemote
Maxxyz Compact
MaxModule Cerebrum
MaxModule Programmer
MaxModule Playback
MaxModule Submaster
MaxModule Button
MaxModule Frame
•
•
•
•
LightJockey 2
2510 Controller
Colorfox
MUM/DABS1
•
•
•
•
Maxedia Broadcast
Maxedia PRO
Maxedia Compact
Maxedia Capture Card
• Martin ShowDesigner
•
•
•
•
Ether2DMX8
USB Duo DMX Interface
Martin DMX 5.3 Splitter
Martin RDM 5.5 Splitter
125
Martin M1™
Maxxyz
Compact™
M2GO™
M2PC™
MaxModule
Button™
MaxModule
Submaster™
MaxModule
Playback™
Core 2
Pentium M
Embedded Dual Core
On PC
n/a
n/a
n/a
RAM
2GB
1GB
4GB
On PC
n/a
n/a
n/a
Internal Screen
1x Touch widescreen
1280x800
1x Touch 800x600
1 x 3.5” Touchscreen
1 x 3.5” Touchscreen
n/a
n/a
n/a
External Screen
1x VGA or 1x DVI max
3880x1024
1x VGA max 1920X1200
1x VGA 1X HDMI
On PC
n/a
n/a
n/a
DMX512 Out/in
4/1
4/1
4 bidirectional
2 (+ 2 optional)
bidirectional
2/0
2/0
2/0
MIDI
In/Out/Thru (optional)
In/Out/Thru
In/Out/Thru (optional)
In/Out/Thru (optional)
n/a
n/a
n/a
SMPTE
External (optional)
1x XLR, 1x BNC
In/Out (optional)
In/Out (optional)
n/a
n/a
n/a
Playback Faders
10 x 60mm non Motorized
10 motorized
10 x 60 mm
10 x 60 mm
n/a
none
10 motorized
Playback LCD
None
10 x 60 mm motorized
No
No
30 high res
2x 40x2 char
10 high res
Playback Buttons
Go, Pause, Flash, Select
Go, Pause, Flash, Select
n/a
Flash (user define)
Go, Pause, Flash
Playback
Submaster Faders
12 x 40mm faders
none
No
No
n/a
24 x 40mm faders
none
Playback
Submaster Buttons
24 x tact-switch
none
No
No
30 x tact-switch
24 x tact-switch
none
Playback bank
endcoder
2
1
No
No
3
1
2
Grandmaster
+ Bump
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
n/a
n/a
n/a
Flashmaster
No
Yes
No
No
n/a
n/a
n/a
Artnet Support
2048 Channels Basic
8192 with additional
licenses
32 Universes, 16384
channels
8 Universes
Up to 64 Universes
n/a
n/a
n/a
Dimensions
(L x W x H)
823 x 464 x 178 mm
730 x 700 x 300 mm
300 x 540 x 99 mm
300 x 540 x 99 mm
275 x 483 x 128 mm
275 x 483 x 128 mm
275 x 483 x 128 mm
Weight
14.4 kg (31.7 lb.)
31 kg (68.2 lb.)
5.2 kg
4.6 kg
4.9 kg (10.8 lb.)
4.6 kg (10.1 lb.)
4.6 kg (10.1 lb.)
CONTROL
Processor
127
M1™
Control and Programming
Protocol: DMX512A (RDM), Artnet2
4 DMX universes, expandable to 16
2048 channels, expandable to 8192
No limit to number of DMX channels per fixture
Extensive fixture library for all known manufacturers
65000 presets for each group of functions (P/T, color, gobo, etc.)
Effect generator for automated programming of complex effects
Relative or absolute programming
Fan function for all channels (including timing parameters)
On-the-fly global timing changes
Virtual cuelists
Macros
Wait, follow and link cues
HTP, LTP, chase, timecode, submaster and group master playback functionality
Individual parameter timings
Intuitive patch feature
Fixture type cloning
All channels with 16-bit resolution
Control/User Interface
Features
• High resolution folding
touchscreen
• Digital LCD buttons for fast
and direct parameter access
• Multiple wing attachment
(MaxModules)
• 4x DMX Universes direct from
the console, up to 16 Universes
with optional license
• Mx Manager Software for
programming and triggering via
time and calendar schedules
• Customizable Graphical User
Interface with context sensitive
toolbars and integrated help
menu
• Powerful effects engine
• Controls up to 8192 parameters
• 1000 cuelists with fader control
• 1000 cuelists with playback
control buttons
• Two separate playback sections
• Parallel execution of multiple
cuelists
• Submaster, groupmaster and
override functionality
• Parameter and time-fanning
functionality
• Auto update for presets and
cues
• On-the-fly global timing
adjustments
CONTROL
M1 is the next generation lighting controller from Martin
Professional. With the full power of a larger desk and the agility
of a smaller one, the M1 is a state-of-the-art, all-in-one lighting
desk. Following the philosophy and simplicity of our current
controller platform, the Martin M1 sets a new standard as the
most powerful and affordable full-featured lighting console on
the market.
Main playback
10 x 60 mm (2.4 in.) playback faders, each with four function-assignable buttons
Sub playback
24 playbacks
12 x 40 mm (1.6 in.) playback faders with one assignable button
12 x single assignable buttons
Other controls
2 x scrollwheels for bank changes
12 x customizable multi-function keys
Playback Select button
Master Go section with Go, Pause, Snap and Release
4 x digital rotary encoders with push function and status LED for fixture parameter control
5 x dynamically labeled digital LCD buttons for parameter groups, effect parameters,
fanning and global timings
Grand master fader and button
Blind/preview button
Customizable highlight/lowlight function
Customizable parameter defaults
Next/last fixtures/groups
Trackball with pan/tilt control switch
Left/right mouse button
Large command keys
Playback
Assign a cue, cuelist or effect to any playback fader
500 playback banks, each containing 10 playbacks
500 sub playback banks, each containing 24 playbacks
100 pages of 100 playbacks activated by touchscreen button
No limit to cues per cuelist
Full 16-bit fading for high-resolution fixtures
Individual fade in/fade out times for all playbacks
Manual override available at all times
Live 0-1000% override of global cue timings
Live programmer timing (Sneak)
Cuelists can be executed in tracking or non-tracking mode
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 823 mm (32.4 in.)
464 mm (18.3 in.)
178 mm (7.0 in.) closed; 395 mm (15.6 in.) open
14.4 kg (31.7 lbs.)
129
M1™
M2GO™
Specifications
Hardware
Industrial 13.1-inch TFT 16:9 touchscreen (1280 x 800 pixels)
Internal SATA 2.5 hard disk drive
Modular construction
Industrial motherboard with Intel Dual-Core processor
2GB RAM
Integrated graphics
2 x dimmable XLR desk lamp connections
Software
Industrial Windows Embedded OS
OS installation by USB storage device
Show backup on hard disk or USB storage device (not included)
Support for ELO USB touchscreens
Connections
Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Included Items
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, EU (Schuko), 3-pin IEC: 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, US, 3-pin IEC: 2 LED desk lamps w/angular plug: User documentation CD
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
P/N 11501012
P/N 11501502
P/N 91613037
Accessories
USB-MIDI port module: LED desk lamp w/angular plug: P/N 91613038
P/N 91613037
Ordering Information
Martin M1 ts Console: M1 Optional 4 DMX Universes Pack (max 3 per M1): M1 Optional flightcase: P/N 90732040
P/N 39808013
P/N 91535070
Equipped with a fast, dual-core processor with no external
computer required, the M2GO answers the demand for a
more powerful lighting console in a smaller form. It offers a
professional level of features in a portable package and has
been developed with cost, ergonomics, feature set, size and
weight in mind. The Martin M2GO again sets a new standard as
the most powerful and affordable full-featured lighting console
on the market.
CONTROL
4 x DMX universe outputs: 5-pin locking XLR
External monitor screen: VGA or DVI
Artnet for up to 16 DMX: RJ-45
MaxNet controller link: RJ-45
2 x MaxModule Interface: RJ45 Ethercon
7 x storage media/hardware peripherals: USB 2.0
MIDI in/out/thru (MIDI show control, MIDI notes, MIDI timecode): Optional
2 x desk lamps: XLR
AC power input: 3-pin IEC
AC power throughput: 3-pin IEC (6 A max.)
Features
• Built-in Industrial Dual Core
CPU, 32GB SSD, 4GB RAM,
HDMI, VGA, Dual Gigabit
Artnet and Maxnet
• 3.5 touchscreen for fast and
direct parameter access
• 4 digital encoders for
parameters
• 8 customizable function keys
• 4 DMX ports standard;
additional external DMX ports
can be added as options
• Controls up to 4096 parameters
• Standard license for 4
Universes; up to 8 Universes
with optional expansion license
pack
• Customizable Graphical User
Interface with context sensitive
toolbars and integrated Help
menu
• Powerful effects engine
• 1000 cuelists with fader control
• 1000 cuelists with playback
control buttons
• Parallel execution of multiple
cuelists
• Submaster, Groupmaster and
Override functionality
• Parameter and Time-fanning
functionality
• Auto update for presets and
cues
• On-the-fly global timing
adjustments
• Up to 4x DMX Universes direct
from the console; up to 8
Universes with optional license
• Mx Manager Software for
programming and triggering via
time and calendar schedules
• Multiple wing attachment
(MaxModules)
131
M2GO™
M2GO™
Specifications
Software
Industrial Windows 7 embedded OS
OS installation by USB storage device
Show backup on SSD disk or USB storage device (not included)
Supports Elo USB, generic Windows 7 and DisplayLink-compatible touch devices
Connections
4 x DMX universe outputs: 5-pin locking XLR
External monitor screen: VGA and HDMI
Artnet for up to 8 DMX universes in total: Gigabit RJ-45
MaxNet controller link: Gigabit RJ-45
5 x storage media/hardware peripherals: USB 2.0
Ready to receive internal MIDI module and SMPTE timecode module
Internal MIDI in/out/thru (MIDI show control, MIDI notes, MIDI timecode): Optional
Internal SMPTE Timecode In/Out: 3-pin XLR (optional)
12 VDC power supply input: 4-pin XLR
Desk lamp (dimmable): XLR
Electrical
AC mains power to 12 VDC external PSU (included): 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Maximum current: 1.4 A
12 VDC output: 5 A, 60 W max.
Included Items
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, EU (Schuko), 3-pin IEC
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, US, 3-pin IEC
MW 12 VDC 5 A external PSU
LED desk lamp w/angular plug
Martin Show Designer 5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
User documentation CD
Accessories
Replacement 12 VDC external PSU: P/N 91613100
Replacement LED desk lamp: P/N 91613090
Related Items
Martin Ether2DMX8: P/N 90758130
Martin USB Duo USB/DMX interface box: P/N 90703010
Ordering Information
M2GO Console: P/N 90737000
Two DMX Universes Expansion License: P/N 39808031
Optional Two DMX Ports PCB: P/N 90703030
Optional Midi PCB: P/N 91613038
Optional SMPTE Timecode PCB: P/N 90703040
CONTROL
Physical
Length: 300 mm (11.8 in.)
Width: 540 mm (21.2 in.)
Height: 99 mm (3.9 in.)
Weight: 5.2 kg (11.5 lbs.)
Control and Programming
Protocol: DMX512A (RDM), Artnet2
4 DMX universes, expandable to 8
2048 channels, expandable to 4096
No limit to number of DMX channels per fixture
Extensive fixture library for all known manufacturers
65000 presets for each group of functions (P/T, color, gobo, etc.)
Effect generator for automated programming of complex effects
Customizable highlight and lowlight function to identify individual fixtures
Relative or absolute programming
Fan function for all channels (including timing parameters)
On-the-fly global timing changes
Virtual cuelists
Macros
Wait, follow and link cues
HTP, LTP, chase, timecode, submaster and group master playback functionality
Individual parameter timings
Intuitive patch feature
Fixture type cloning
All channels with 16-bit resolution
Control/User Interface
Main playback interface: Ten 60 mm (2.4 in.) playback faders, each with four function-assignable buttons
Eight customizable multi-function keys
Playback Select button
Master Go section with Go, Pause, Snap and Release
Four digital rotary encoders with push function and status LED for fixture parameter
control
3.5 touch screen for parameter groups, effect parameters, fanning and global
timings
Grand master rotary fader and button
Blind/preview button
Customizable highlight/lowlight function
Customizable parameter defaults
Next/last fixtures/groups
Large command keys
Playback
Assign a cue, cuelist or effect to any playback fader
100 playback banks, each containing 10 playbacks
100 pages of 100 playbacks activated by touch screen button
No limit to cues per cuelist
Full 16-bit fading for high-resolution fixtures
Individual fade in/fade out times for all playbacks
Manual override available at all times
Live 0-1000% override of global cue timings
Live programmer timing (Sneak)
Cuelists can be executed in tracking or non-tracking mode
Hardware
Industrial 3.5” RGB touchscreen
Internal 32 GB SSD storage drive
Industrial motherboard with dual-core processor
4 GB RAM
Integrated graphics processor
133
M2PC™
Specifications
Features
• USB 2.0 Connection to
Windows PC
• 3.5 touchscreen for fast and
direct parameter access
• 4 digital encoders for
parameters
• 8 customizable function keys
• 2 DMX ports standard; 2
additional internal DMX ports
can be added as options
• Standard license for 4
Universes - up to 64 Universes
with optional expansion license
pack
• Controls up to 32768
parameters
• Customizable Graphical User
Interface with context sensitive
toolbars and integrated Help
menu
• Powerful effects engine
• 1000 cuelists with fader control
• 1000 cuelists with playback
control buttons
• Parallel execution of multiple
cuelists
• Submaster, Groupmaster and
Override functionality
• Parameter and Time-fanning
functionality
• Auto update for presets and
cues
• On-the-fly global timing
adjustments
• Mx Manager Software for
programming and triggering via
time and calendar schedules
• Multiple wing attachment
(MaxModules)
CONTROL
M2PC is the complementary control surface to Martin’s M-PC
controller software. Featuring the same layout and portable
size as the M2GO, the M2PC delivers a professional level
of features directly from any PC. Following the philosophy
and simplicity of our current controller platform, such as the
Martin M1, the Martin M2PC is one of the most powerful and
affordable PC-based lighting controllers on the market.
Physical
Length: 300 mm (11.8 in.)
Width: 540 mm (21.2 in.)
Height: 99 mm (3.9 in.)
Weight: 4.6 kg (10.2 lbs.)
Control and Programming
Protocol: DMX512A (RDM), Artnet2
4 DMX universes, expandable to 64
2048 channels, expandable to 32768
No limit to number of DMX channels per fixture
Extensive fixture library for all known manufacturers
65000 presets for each group of functions (P/T, color, gobo, etc.)
Effect generator for automated programming of complex effects
Customizable highlight and lowlight function to identify individual fixtures
Relative or absolute programming
Fan function for all channels (including timing parameters)
On-the-fly global timing changes
Virtual cuelists
Macros
Wait, follow and link cues
HTP, LTP, chase, timecode, submaster and group master playback functionality
Individual parameter timings
Intuitive patch feature
Fixture type cloning
All channels with 16-bit resolution
Control/User
Interface Main playback interface: Ten 60 mm (2.4 in.) playback faders, each with four function-assignable buttons
Eight customizable multi-function keys
Playback Select button
Master Go section with Go, Pause, Snap and Release
Four digital rotary encoders with push function and status LED for fixture
parameter control
3.5 touch screen for parameter groups, effect parameters, fanning and
global timings
Grand master rotary fader and button
Blind/preview button
Customizable highlight/lowlight function
Customizable parameter defaults
Next/last fixtures/groups
Large command keys
Playback
Assign a cue, cuelist or effect to any playback fader
100 playback banks, each containing 10 playbacks
100 pages of 100 playbacks activated by touch screen button
No limit to cues per cuelist
Full 16-bit fading for high-resolution fixtures
Individual fade in/fade out times for all playbacks
Manual override available at all times
Live 0-1000% override of global cue timings
Live programmer timing (Sneak)
Cuelists can be executed in tracking or non-tracking mode
Software
Uses Martin M-PC software on any Windows XP, Windows 7 (32 or 64-bit) PC
135
M2PC™
MPC™
Specifications
This Windows-compatible version of the Maxxyz and M-Series
console is an online and offline editing tool that gives you total
functionality from the ease and convenience of a PC or laptop.
It is ideal for training purposes and preprogramming of shows.
CONTROL
Connections
2 x DMX universe outputs: 5-pin locking XLR
Additional 2 x internal DMX universe outputs: 5-pin locking XLR (optional)
Ready to receive internal MIDI module and SMPTE timecode module
Internal MIDI in/out/thru (MIDI show control, MIDI notes, MIDI timecode): Optional
Internal SMPTE Timecode In/Out: 3-pin XLR (optional)
12 VDC power supply input: 4-pin XLR
Desk lamp: XLR
Electrical
AC mains power to 12 VDC external PSU (included): 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Maximum current: 1.4 A
12 VDC output: 5 A, 60 W max.
Included Items
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, EU (Schuko), 3-pin IEC
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, US, 3-pin IEC
MW 12 VDC 5 A external PSU
LED desk lamp w/angular plug
Martin Show Designer 5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
User documentation CD
Accessories
Replacement 12 VDC external PSU: P/N 91613100
Replacement LED desk lamp: P/N 91613090
Related Items
Martin Ether2DMX8: P/N 90758130
Martin USB Duo USB/DMX interface box: P/N 90703010
Ordering Information
M2PC Console: P/N 90737010
Two DMX Universes Expansion License: P/N 39808031
Optional Two DMX Ports PCB: P/N 90703030
Optional Midi PCB: P/N 91613038
Optional SMPTE Timecode PCB: P/N 90703040
Features
• Support for 64 DMX universes
in Pro Edition and 8 in Basic
Edition
• Offline and online
programming
• 1024 channels in Demo mode
using Martin USB Duo DMX
or Martin Universal USB DMX
interface
• Mx Manager Software for
programming and triggering via
time and calendar schedules
• Customizable Graphical User
Interface with context sensitive
toolbars and integrated help
menu
• Powerful effects engine
• Controls up to 32768 fixtures
in Pro Edition (4096 in Basic
Edition)
• 1000 cuelists with motorized
fader control
• 1000 cuelists with playback
control buttons
• Keyboard shortcuts
• 12 customizable function keys
• Parallel execution of multiple
cuelists
• Submaster, groupmaster and
override functionality
• 3D visualizer integrated
• Full compatibility with Maxxyz
and M-Series console
• Fanning functionality
• Auto update for presets
and cues, including ‘track
backwards’
• On-the-fly global timing
adjustments
• Networking with Maxedia
media server CITP protocol
137
MPC™
MPC™
Specifications
Control and Programming
Control/User Interface
All controls listed below are virtual, on-screen only, and are operated via touch screen or mouse click
Real-world paradigm intuitive interface
(images, dynamic text labels and actuals prefered to figures)
10 x playback faders, each with one dynamically labeled LCD button (to identify/activate
playback) and two function-assignable buttons
8 x digital fader belts for fixture parameter control
15 x dynamically labeled digital LCD buttons for parameter groups, functions, effect
parameters, fanning, global timings
Grand master fader and button
Flash master fader and button
Two group master faders and buttons
16 x view buttons, 4 x view scroll buttons
Blind/preview button
12 x customizable function keys, F1 to F12
Highlight function
Next/last fixtures/groups
Numeric and functional keypad
Main playback control section
Playback
Assign a cue, cuelist or effect to any playback fader
500 playback banks, each containing 10 playbacks, can all be active simultaneously
No limit to cues per cuelist
100 pages of 100 playbacks activated by touch screen button
Full 16-bit fading for high-resolution fixtures
Individual fade in/fade out times for all playbacks
Manual override available at all times
Live 0-1000% override of global cue timings
Live programmer timing (“Sneak”)
Go-function (supports multiple cues simultaneously)
Cuelists can be executed in tracking or non-tracking mode
Minimum System Requirements
Windows XP (Home or Pro) with SP3 (Windows 7 Pro recommended)
Pentium 4 (Intel Core Duo recommended)
1024 MB RAM (3 GB recommended)
500 MB available hard disk space
Display with 1024 x 768 resolution
CD-ROM drive
USB 1.1 (or higher) port for dongle
Full administrator rights on PC
USB 1.1 (or higher) port if Martin Universal USB/DMX Interface or
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface is used
10/100 Ethernet port for ArtNet DMX output
Second Ethernet port required for remote communication such as CITP or Backup system.
Environment
Up to 64 DMX universes with M-PC Pro and 8 DMX universes with M-PC Basic
Direct communication with MaxModules via USB
ArtNet-compatible DMX distribution
Supports Martin Universal USB/DMX Interface and Martin USB Duo DMX Interface
Supports All MaxModules
Free Mx Manager add-on for custom user interfaces and advanced scheduling,
astronomical clock, supports GPS, commands by RS232, Telnet, HTML
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
Compatible with Martin Show Designer
Sending on DMX channels requires the dongle and additional hardware such as the
Universal USB/DMX Interface or USB Duo DMX Interface
CONTROL
Protocol: DMX512, Artnet RDM compatible
Up to 64 DMX universes, (8 in Basic Edition)
Up to 32768 channels in Pro Edition (4096 in Basic Edition)
No limit to number of DMX channels per fixture
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
Extensive fixture library for all known manufacturers
65000 presets for each group of functions (P/T, color, gobo, etc.)
Effect generator for automated programming of complex effects
Customizable highlight and lowlight function to identify individual fixtures
Relative or absolute programming
Fan function for all channels (including timing parameters)
On-the-fly global timing changes
Virtual cuelists
Macros
Wait, follow and link cues
HTP, LTP, chase, timecode, submaster and group master playback functionality
Individual parameter timings
Intuitive patch feature
Fixture type cloning
All channels with 16-bit resolution
Included Items
M-PC protection dongle
M-PC installation CD
MSD-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
Martin USB Duo DMX: P/N 90703010
Accessories
Ether2DMX8: MaxModule Programmer: MaxModule Playback: MaxModule Submaster: MaxModule Button: P/N 90758130
P/N 90732150
P/N 90732180
P/N 90732170
P/N 90732160
Ordering Information
M-PC Pro: M-PC Basic: MPC Basic (8 universes max license only):
MPC Pro (64 universes max license only):
P/N 90732010
P/N 90732070
P/N 39808017
P/N 39808016
139
Maxxyz Compact™
The iOS MAXRemote is your personal assistant to remotely
control lighting devices straight from an iPhone, iPad or iPod
touch. It is the ultimate remote tool for the Martin Maxxyz,
M-Series lighting console and M-PC - the ideal tool for updating presets on stage. It features a beautiful user interface and
original features. The iOS MAXRemote is available exclusively
through the Apple Store at no charge.
Maxxyz Compact offers full M-Series functionality and an
intuitive philosophy in a mid-sized console. Its compact size and
modular design make this professional lighting console ideal for
all manner of productions.
Features
• Automatic discovery
• Controls Maxxyz and
M-Series remotely
• Black skin for dark
environments
• Integrated help
• Passcode protected
• Saves show data for fast follow
up synchronization
• Controls all fixtures in a show
• Integrated fixture search
• Create and edit presets
• Pan/Tilt view with built-in
accelerometer support under
sensor mode
• Color picker with support for
Lee, Rosco and GAM filters
• Easy manipulation of all DMX
channels
• Fast menu appears when
shaking device (clears values
quickly)
• Browse through fixture groups
in a cover flow-like interface
under landscape mode
• Start, pause and release
cuelists, chases, etc.
• Exclusively for iPhone, iPad and
iPod touch
CONTROL
iOS MAXRemote™
Features
• Digital LCD buttons for fast
and direct programming
• Multiple wing attachment
(MaxModules)
• Up to 32 DMX universes, 4
available directly from the
console
• Mx Manager Software for
programming and triggering via
time and calendar schedules
• Customizable Graphical User
Interface with context sensitive
toolbars and integrated help
menu
• Powerful effects engine
• Controls up to 16384 fixtures
• 1000 cuelists with motorized
fader control
• 1000 cuelists with playback
control buttons
• 5 customizable LCD function
keys
• Parallel execution of multiple
cuelists
• Submaster, groupmaster and
override functionality
• Parameter and time-fanning
functionality
• Auto update for presets and
cues
• On-the-fly global timing
adjustments
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 730 mm (28.7 in.)
700 mm (27.6 in.)
300 mm (11.8 in.)
31 kg (68.3 in.)
141
Maxxyz Compact™
Maxxyz Compact™
Specifications
Control and Programming
Control/User Interface
10 x motorized playback faders, each with one dynamically labeled LCD button
(to identify/activate playback) and two function-assignable buttons
4 x digital fader belts for fixture parameter control
10 x dynamically labeled digital LCD buttons for parameter groups, functions,
effect parameters, fanning, global timings
Grand master fader and button
Flash master fader and button
Trackball with pan/tilt control switch
16 x view buttons, 2 x view scroll buttons
Blind/preview button
10 x pause/back buttons
10 x go buttons
10 x flash buttons
5 x customizable function keys, LCD buttons
Customizable highlight/lowlight function
Next/last fixtures/groups
Left/right mouse button
Digital encoder wheels for window scrolling and screen/desk lamp intensity
Playback
Assign a cue, cuelist or effect to any playback fader
500 playback banks, each containing 10 playbacks, can all be active simultaneously
No limit to cues per cuelist
100 pages of 100 playbacks activated by touch screen button
Full 16-bit fading for high-resolution fixtures
Individual fade in/fade out times for all playbacks
Manual override available at all times
Live 0-1000% override of global cue timings
Live programmer timing (“Sneak”)
Go-function (supports multiple cues simultaneously)
Cuelists can be executed in tracking or non-tracking mode
Hardware
Industrial SVGA 12.1” TFT color touch monitor screen
Internal SATA 2.5” hard disc drive
Modular construction
Industrial motherboard with Pentium M processor
DVD/CD drive (not intended for movie playback)
2 x integrated dimmable LED desk lamps
Integrated slide-out QWERTY keyboard
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.22 No. 60950-1
Software
Industrial Windows XP Embedded OS (not user-accessible)
Real-world paradigm intuitive interface (images, dynamic text labels and actuals)
Show backup on hard disk or USB storage device (not included)
Compatible with Martin ShowDesigner
Connections
4 x DMX universe outputs: 5-pin locking XLR
External monitor screen: VGA
Artnet for addition of up to 32 DMX universes: RJ-45
MaxNet controller link: RJ-45
2 x MaxModules interfaces: RJ-45
4 x storage media/hardware peripherals: USB 2.0
MIDI in/out/thru (MIDI show control, MIDI notes, MIDI timecode): Standard MIDI (5-pin DIN)
SMPTE timecode in: 3-pin locking XLR
LTC timecode in: BNC
2 x desk lamps: XLR
AC power input: 3-pin IEC
CONTROL
Protocol: DMX512, Artnet (ACN and RDM pending)
4 DMX universes, expandable to 32
2048 channels, expandable to 16384
No limit to number of DMX channels per fixture
Extensive fixture library for all known manufacturers
65000 presets for each group of functions (P/T, color, gobo, etc.)
Effect generator for automated programming of complex effects
Customizable highlight and lowlight function to identify individual fixtures
Relative or absolute programming
Fan function for all channels (including timing parameters)
On-the-fly global timing changes
Virtual cuelists
Macros
Wait, follow and link cues
HTP, LTP, chase, timecode, submaster and group master playback functionality
Individual parameter timings
Intuitive patch feature
Fixture type cloning
All channels with 16-bit resolution
Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Included Items
Maxxyz Compact dust cover:
Maxxyz Compact monitor bracket, left:
Maxxyz Compact monitor bracket, right:
Four 3-pin female to 5-pin male XLR adapters:
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC:
User documentation CD
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
P/N 33302008
P/N 55732076
P/N 55732074
P/N 91613024
P/N 11501012
Accessories
Maxxyz Compact desk lamp:
Ether2DMX8:
MaxModule Playback:
MaxModule Submaster:
MaxModule Button:
MaxModule Frame (empty) in Flightcase:
MaxModule Frame (empty) in Cardboard Box:
P/N 91613036
P/N 90758130
P/N 90732180
P/N 90732170
P/N 90732160
P/N 90732120
P/N 90732130
Ordering Information
Maxxyz Compact Controller:
P/N 90732020
143
MaxModule Cerebrum™
Control and Programming
Protocol:
DMX512, Artnet (ACN and RDM pending)
2 physical DMX universes, expandable to 32 via Artnet or USB/DMX interface
32 universes or 16384 channels from a single Cerebrum
No limit to number of DMX channels per fixture
Extensive fixture library for all known manufacturers
65000 presets for each group of functions (P/T, color, gobo, etc.)
Effect generator for automated programming of complex effects
Customizable highlight and lowlight function to identify individual fixtures
Relative or absolute programming
Fan function for all channels (including timing parameters)
On-the-fly global timing changes
Virtual cuelists
Macros
Wait, follow and link cues
HTP, LTP, chase, timecode, submaster and group master playback functionality
Individual parameter timings
Intuitive patch feature
Fixture type cloning
Mx Manager for scheduling (astronomical clock) and remote triggering via Intenet
Features
• Industrial motherboard with
Pentium M processor
• Industrial SVGA 12.1_ TFT color
touch monitor screen
• Real-world paradigm intuitive
interface (images, dynamic text
labels and actuals)
• Customizable GUI
(Graphic User Interface)
• 16 x view buttons, 2 x view
scroll buttons
• 2 physical DMX universes,
expandable to 32 via Artnet or
USB/DMX interface
• Mx Manager for scheduling
(astronomical clock) and
remote triggering via Internet
Customizable GUI
Grand master fader and button
Flash master fader and button
16 x view buttons, 2 x view scroll buttons
Customizable highlight/lowlight function
Digital encoder wheels for window scrolling and screen/desk lamp intensity
CONTROL
Control/User Interface
The Cerebrum module is a compact yet powerful touch-screen
computer and the heart of the MaxModule concept. It runs the
lighting software on Windows XP Embedded which controls the
Maxxyz Compact and M-Series. The MaxModule Cerebrum can
also be used as a stand-alone unit for control in installations
and also functions as a backup system for any Maxxyz, M-Series
and M-PC or other Cerebrum module.
Playback
Full 16-bit fading for high-resolution fixtures
Individual fade in/fade out times for all playbacks
Manual override available at all times
Live 0-1000% override of global cue timings
Live programmer timing (Sneak)
Go-function (supports multiple cues simultaneously)
Cuelists can be executed in tracking or non-tracking mode
Hardware
Industrial SVGA 12.1 TFT color touch monitor screen
Internal SATA 2.5 hard disk drive
Modular construction
Industrial motherboard with Pentium M processor
Internal Martin One-Key software protection dongle
Software
Industrial Windows XP Embedded OS (not user-accessible)
Real-world paradigm intuitive interface (images, dynamic text labels and actuals)
Show backup on hard disk or USB storage device (not included)
Compatible with Martin ShowDesigner
Connections
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 275 mm (10.8 in.)
483 mm (19.0 in.)
182 mm (7.2 in.)
7.3 kg (16.1 lbs.)
DMX in: 5-pin locking XLR
DMX out: 5-pin locking XLR
External monitor screen: VGA (15- pin D-sub female)
Artnet for addition of up to 32 DMX universes:
Neutrik RJ-45 socket (accepts Neutrik EtherCon connectors in housing)
M-Series/Maxedia multiple controller link USB:
Neutrik RJ-45 socket (accepts Neutrik EtherCon connectors in housing)
Ethernet for multiple controller link:
Neutrik RJ-45 socket (accepts Neutrik EtherCon connectors in housing)
USB devices: USB host socket
Desk lamp: 2.5 mm (0.1 in.) DC bayonet
Microphone: 6.3mm (1/4-inch) mono jack
Audio in/out: RCA phono
AC power input: 3-pin IEC male socket
AC power throughput: 3-pin IEC female socket
145
MaxModule Cerebrum™
MaxModule Programmer™
Specifications
Electrical
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuses: Desk lamp output: AC power output: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
2 AT (x 2)
12 V
Unswitched, unfused, max. 6 A
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.22 No. 60950-1
Included Items
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC: Ethercon patch cable: USB cable (A/B), 1000 mm (39.4 in.): Recovery DVD, Maxxyz Compact/Cerebrum
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
P/N 11501012
P/N 11840144
P/N 11840066
MaxModule Cerebrum: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Flightcase: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Cardboard Box: P/N 90732140
P/N 90732120
P/N 90732130
The Programmer module is the main control unit of the M-Series
system. This module can be used with the Cerebrum or with the
M-PC software and it allows the user to be quick and efficient
while programming a show - the perfect startup M-Series
Console.
CONTROL
Ordering Information
Features
• 4 x digital fader belts for fixture
parameter control
• Trackball with pan/tilt control
switch
• Blind/preview button
• Customizable highlight/lowlight
function
• Next/last fixtures/groups
• Left/right mouse button
• Customizable LCD function
keys for function shortcuts
• M-PC key built-in
• Built-in M-PC dongle
and 2 built-in DMX ports
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 275 mm (10.8 in.)
483 mm (19.0 in.)
128 mm (5.0 in.)
5 kg (11.0 lbs.)
147
MaxModule Programmer™
MaxModule Playback™
Specifications
Control/User Interface
4 x digital fader belts for fixture parameter control
Trackball with pan/tilt control switch
Blind/preview button
Customizable highlight/lowlight function
Next/last fixtures/groups
Left/right mouse button
Customizable LCD function keys for function shortcut
Connections
M-Series/Maxedia multiple controller link USB: DMX out: USB input: USB devices: Desk lamp: AC power input: AC power throughput: Neutrik locking RJ45 Ethercon sockets
2 x 5-pin female locking XLR
USB device socket
USB host socket
2.5 mm (0.1 in.) DC bayonet
3-pin IEC male socket
3-pin IEC female socket
Electrical
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
2 AT (slow blow)
12 V
Unswitched, unfused, max. 6 A
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC:
US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.22 No. 60950-1
The Playback module extends the playback capabilities of any
M-Series console by adding 10 motorized faders with 15 LCD
buttons and a master Go section. Up to 16 Playback modules
can be added to any MaxModule Cerebrum, Maxxyz, M-Series
consoles or M-PC.
CONTROL
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Desk lamp output: AC power output: Included Items
M-PC key installed internally
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC: Ethercon patch cable: USB cable: DVD with M-PC and Mx Manager software
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
P/N 11501012
P/N 11840144
P/N 11840066
Ordering Information
MaxModule Programmer: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Flightcase: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Cardboard Box: P/N 90732150
P/N 90732120
P/N 90732130
Features
• 10 x motorized playback faders,
each with one dynamically
labeled LCD button (to identify/
activate playback) and two
function-assignable buttons
• 10 x pause/back buttons
• 10 x go buttons
• 10 x flash buttons
• 5 x LCD navigation buttons
with scroll wheel
• Master Go section
• Built-in M-PC dongle and
2 built-in DMX ports
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 275 mm (10.8 in.)
483 mm (19.0 in.)
128 mm (5.0 in.)
4.6 kg (10.1 lbs.)
149
MaxModule Playback™
MaxModule Submaster™
Specifications
Control/User Interface
10 x motorized playback faders, each with one dynamically labeled LCD button
(to identify/activate playback) and two function-assignable buttons
10 x pause/back buttons
10 x go buttons
10 x flash buttons
5 x LCD navigation buttons with scroll wheel
Master Go section
Connections
M-Series/Maxedia multiple controller link USB: Neutrik locking RJ45 Ethercon sockets
DMX out: 2 x 5-pin female locking XLR
USB input: USB device socket
USB devices: USB host socket
Desk lamp: 2.5 mm (0.1 in.) DC bayonet
AC power input: 3-pin IEC male socket
AC power throughput: 3-pin IEC female socket
Electrical
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
2 AT (slow blow)
12 V
Unswitched, unfused, max. 6 A
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC:
US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.22 No. 60950-1
The Submaster module provides the user with an additional
24 handles of controls for cuelists, channels, submasters or
inhibitives. Combined with a MaxModule Cerebrum, Maxxyz,
M-Series consoles or M-PC, the Submaster module makes it
easy and relatively inexpensive to build a 24, 48 or even 96 fader
desk - the perfect startup theater console.
CONTROL
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Desk lamp output: AC power output: Included Items
M-PC key installed internally
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC: Ethercon patch cable: USB cable: DVD with M-PC and Mx Manager software
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
P/N 11501012
P/N 11840144
P/N 11840066
Ordering Information
MaxModule Playback: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Flightcase: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Cardboard Box: P/N 90732180
P/N 90732120
P/N 90732130
Features
• 24 x non-motorized faders with
single function button (every
cuelist type supported)
• 40-character display for
labeling
• 5 x LCD navigation buttons
with scroll wheel
• Built-in M-PC dongle and 2
built-in DMX ports
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 275 mm (10.8 in.)
483 mm (19.0 in.)
128 mm (5.0 in.)
4.6 kg (10.1 lbs.)
151
MaxModule Submaster™
MaxModule Button™
Specifications
Control/User Interface
24 x non-motorized faders with single function button (every cuelist type supported)
40-character display for labeling
5 x LCD navigation buttons with scroll wheel
Connections
M-Series/Maxedia multiple controller link USB: DMX out: USB input: USB devices: Desk lamp:
AC power input: AC power throughput: Neutrik locking RJ45 Ethercon sockets
2 x 5-pin female locking XLR
USB device socket
USB host socket
2.5 mm (0.1 in.) DC bayonet
3-pin IEC male socket
3-pin IEC female socket
Electrical
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
2 AT (slow blow)
12 V
Unswitched, unfused, max. 6 A
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety:
Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.22 No. 60950-1
Included Items
M-PC key installed internally
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC: Ethercon patch cable: USB cable: DVD with M-PC and Mx Manager software
P/N 11501012
P/N 11840144
P/N 11840066
The Button module offers up to 30 customizable direct access
buttons to satisfy the ever-increasing demand for more direct
access on live shows. Each row of 10 buttons is individually
assignable to cuelists, groups, fixtures or presets by the simple
press of a Mode button. Each row includes 10 LCD buttons, 10
flash buttons and one scroll wheel for direct access to other
banks, pages or rows. MaxModule Button also works directly
with the Maxedia media server as a playback device.
CONTROL
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Desk lamp output: AC power output: Ordering Information
MaxModule Submaster: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Flightcase: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Cardboard Box: P/N 90732170
P/N 90732120
P/N 90732130
Features
• 3 rows of 10 x LCD function
buttons
• 5 x LCD navigation buttons
with scroll wheel
• Digital fader belt for intensity,
speed and timing controls
• Mode buttons for assigning
operating mode to each row
• Playback button mode and
fixture, group and preset
selection modes available
• Built-in M-PC dongle and 2
built-in DMX ports
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 275 mm (10.8 in.)
483 mm (19.0 in.)
128 mm (5.0 in.)
4.9 kg (10.8 lbs.)
153
MaxModule Button™
MaxModule Frame™
Specifications
Control/User Interface
3 rows of 10 x LCD function buttons
5 x LCD navigation buttons with scroll wheel
Digital fader belt for intensity, speed and timing controls
Mode buttons for assigning operating mode to each row
Playback button mode and fixture, group and preset selection modes available
Connections
M-Series/Maxedia multiple controller link USB: Neutrik locking RJ45 Ethercon sockets
DMX out: 2 x 5-pin female locking XLRUSB input: USB device socket
USB devices: USB host socket
Desk lamp: 2.5 mm (0.1 in.) DC bayonet
AC power input: 3-pin IEC male socket
AC power throughput: 3-pin IEC female socket
Electrical
100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
2 AT (slow blow)
12 V
Unswitched, unfused, max. 6 A
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: Canadian safety: EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
UL 60950-1
CAN/CSA C22.22 No. 60950-1
Included Items
M-PC key installed internally1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC:
Ethercon patch cable: USB cable: DVD with M-PC and Mx Manager software
Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
P/N 11501012
P/N 11840144
P/N 11840066
Features
• Supports two MaxModules
• Power and data connections
built-in
• Built-in desk lamp
• Blind plate for paper notes or
laptop support included
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Ordering Information
MaxModule Button: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Flightcase: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Cardboard Box: The MaxModule Frame can accept up to two MaxModules of
any kind (except the Cerebrum which only fits in the upper
position), making it possible to combine different modules in the
same frame - thereby customizing it for a specific application.
The included blind plate can be used to hold a laptop or notes
and paperwork.
CONTROL
AC power: Power supply unit: Main fuse: Desk lamp output: AC power output: P/N 90732160
P/N 90732120
P/N 90732130
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 695 mm (27.4 in.)
526 mm (20.7 in.)
336 mm (13.2 in.)
10.3 kg (22.7 lbs.)
Connections
M-Series/Maxedia multiple controller link USB: Neutrik locking RJ45 Ethercon sockets
AC power input: 3-pin IEC male socket
AC power throughput: 3-pin IEC female socket
Included Items
Desk lamp and cable
Ethercon and power interconnect cables
Blind cover plate (installed): 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC: P/N 62406159
P/N 11501012
Accessories
Maxxyz Compact monitor bracket, left: Maxxyz Compact monitor bracket, right: 3-pin female to 5-pin male XLR adapters: 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC: Wheel set for MaxModules flightcase
Fligtcase for MaxModule Frame: Blind cover plate for MaxModule Frame: Shielded CAT 5e Ethercon cable, ferrite cores,
RJ45 connectors in Neutrik shells, 2m: P/N 55732076
P/N 55732074
P/N 91613024
P/N 11501012
P/N 91535007
P/N 62406159
P/N 11840144
Ordering Information
MaxModule Frame (empty) in Flightcase: MaxModule Frame (empty) in Cardboard Box: P/N 90732120
P/N 90732130
155
LightJockey 2™
Programming
Number of fixtures: Up to 100
Fixture library: All Martin (DMX) fixtures, user-definable profiles for non-Martin fixtures,
generic DMX profiles
Control: Graphical control of all fixture parameters
Visualization: Martin Show Designer-5 MC Edition 45-day trial 3D Visualizer
Macros: Pan and tilt, relative or absolute movement,
shape generator with different shapes and delay styles
LightJockey Manager trigger options
Playback
LightJockey 2 is a flexible, easy-to-use Windows-based controller utilizing a USB to DMX Interface. One of the industry’s
most popular PC-Based controllers for well over a decade,
LightJockey 2 offers lighting designers greater flexibility,
spontaneity and ease of use in a user-focused control package.
Minimum System Requirements
64 MB RAM
Standard PC with Pentium 200 MHz or equivalent
Monitor resolution of 800 x 600 in 16 bit colors, with small fonts
USB port for DMX interface hardware
20+ MB hard disc space
Windows XP/Vista/7 (32bit and 64bit)
CONTROL
Cue contains 12 sequences with global or individual fade time adjustment
Master intensity control + 8 configurable intensity groups
Manual override with direct access to all functions
Independent background cue with 5 parallel sequences
Blackout and fade out function
Go button for manual cue lists
Assignable keyboard hotkeys for faster access
Smoke control independent from programming
Follow spot function
Cue list for synchronisation with timer, digital audio or Audio CD-ROM timecode
Audio analyser for trigging sequences by audio
Function and DMX channel override via DMX IN (depending on interface type)
Recommended
Features
• Windows XP, Windows Vista,
Windows 7 (32bit and 64bit)
based lighting control software
• Large fixture library and userconfigurable editor
• Martin Show Designer-5
MC Edition 45-day trial 3D
Visualizer
• Supports MP3, audio CD,
SMPTE and MIDI timecode
• Martin USB Duo DMX
Interface with 2 x 512 Channels
DMXIN/Out
• Control of up to 100 fixtures,
2048 DMX channels
• Graphical representation of all
fixture functions
• Add-on LightJockey Manager,
free downloadable software for
scheduling events
• LED-Trix plug-in included for
programming color-mixing
fixtures
1024+ MB RAM
Fast graphic card with minimum 256MB
Note: MSD-5 MC Edition 3D visualizer requires good 3D gaming graphic card and 2
Gig RAM Minimum
Pentium 4 or faster
1024 x 768 monitor resolution, 32-bit true color
USB port for DMX interface hardware
Network card (optional)
300+ MB available hard disc space
Windows XP/Vista/7 (32bit and 64bit)
Included Items
Martin LightJockey DMX Software CD
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface and cables:
P/N 90703010
Accessories
2510 Controller, 110-130 V, 60 Hz:
2510 Controller, 220-240 V, 50 Hz:
Martin USB Duo DMX:
P/N 90716100
P/N 90716000
P/N 90703010
Ordering Information
LightJockey Kit with Martin One-Key and Martin USB Duo DMX:
LightJockey (License only):
Specifications
P/N 90702070
P/N 39808015
Physical
Shipping Length: Shipping Width: Shipping Height: Shipping Weight: 275 mm (10.8 in.)
75 mm (3.0 in.)
325 mm (12.8 in.)
1.4 kg (3.1 lbs.)
Control and Programming
Trig sources: Manual, auto, audio input with FFT analyser, DMX in, MIDI, LightJockey Manager
Cue list time code synchronisation (CLTCS) options
Internal timer, including 24-hour clock
Audio CD time code from CD-ROM drive
Digital Audio (MP3, Wav, etc.) time code using Winamp™
MIDI Time code, SMPTE with suitable SMPTE/MTC interface
157
2510 Controller™
Construction
Housing: Finish: Steel and aluminium
Electrostatic powder-coated
Installation
19-inch rack mount (2U)
Connections
AC power input: Data input: Data output: 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) cable tail w/o power plug
RS-232 via DB9 connector
RS-485 via 3-pin XLR, polarity-reversing adapter required to convert
to compliant DMX
Electrical
AC power: US model 100-120 V nominal, 50/60 Hz, EU model 208-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Typical Power and Current
120 V, 60 Hz: 230 V, 50 Hz: 3 W, 0.1 A
3 W, 0.1 A
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: EN 60950
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2
Included Items
P/N 98163009
P/N 91613017
P/N 11820006
P/N 11820008
Ordering Information
2510 Controller, 512 DMX, 100-130 V:
2510 Controller, 512 DMX, 220-240 V:
P/N 90716100
P/N 90716000
CONTROL
The 2510 Controller is a powerful playback controller for an easy
and inexpensive hardware-based control solution.
CD with preprogrammed shows:
DMX termination plug, 3-pin XLR:
Polarity-reversing 3-pin XLR adapter
(converts Martin protocol to DMX):
5 m data cable, 3-pin XLR:
Features
• Record up to 512 DMX
channels from LightJockey
• Easy playback with manual
selection of sequences
• Up to 10 sub-lists of sequences
• Music input for triggering
scenes
• Blackout function
• Download free preprogrammed shows for Mania
SCX and Mania EFX series
Specifications
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 483 mm (19.0 in.)
65 mm (2.6 in.)
89 mm (3.5 in.)
1.0 kg (2.2 lbs.)
Control and Programming
Playback triggering options: Capacity, LightJockey scenes: Capacity 3032 Controller scenes: Sublists of sequences: Instant blackout button
Auto, manual and music trig with built-in microphone
From 247 (512 channels) to 42 325 (1 channel)
8024
Up to 10
Control/User Interface
Two-digit LED display
Menu up/down plus direct access function keys
159
Colorfox™
Programming
Stores up to 4 static/dynamic shows in memory
Edit show programs directly on Windows PC with Pixmove software
Drag-and-drop video and images directly onto preset buttons
RDM automatic fast search and fixture addressing
Advanced matrix addressing for LED panels zig-zag, etc.
Playback
Controls up to 170 luminaires via maximum 512 DMX channels
On-the-fly adjustment of color, saturation and intensity
Master/slave mode (2 units max.)
Minimum System Requirements
PC with Windows XP 32-bit or Vista 32-bit for Pixmove configuration software
Pentium 4 with standard configuration
USB 1.1 (or higher) port
Construction
Housing:
Finish:
Front display/control surface: Aluminum
Clear anodized
Transparent acrylic, all controls touch-sensitive
Installation
Hand-held, wall mount with supplied wall bracket
Features
• Attractive, tactile design with
glossy finish and rounded
edges
• Touch-sensitive dial with
acoustic and visual feedback
• 4 memory buttons to run/store/
adjust your favorite looks and
dynamic scenes
• Select any color fast and easily
by scrolling the color wheel
• Easy mood-setting control: dial
the hue, saturation or intensity
of your lighting
• Matches different luminaire
types (RGB or CMY) to create
identical and consistent colors
• Connects directly to DMX via
RJ45 and controls up to 170
fixtures or zones (maximum
512 channels)
• Connects to any PC via USB
for easy setup and uploading
of new scenes using PixMove
software
Control interface unit
Communication with PC: DMX out and POE in: External power supply unit
DMX in/thru, POE out: AC power input: Remote control device
Contact closure, RS-232 or DMX
USB
RJ-45
2 x RJ45
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) UL-approved power cable
CONTROL
Connections
Colorfox is the first lighting controller specifically designed for
architectural use with dynamic color changing fixtures. This
incredibly simple control solution allows users to customize and
personalize a variety of architectural lighting settings.
Electrical
AC power: Typical current: Output voltage: Auto-ranging 100 - 240 VAC nominal, 50/60 Hz
0.4 A
48 V DC via POE (Power Over Ethernet)
Approvals
EU safety: EU EMC: External power supply unit: EN 60950
EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
CE, UL (C + US), FCC, GS, CCC
Included Items
Control interface unit
IEEE 802.3af (POE) compliant external PSU
Pixmove software CD
UTP network & POE power supply cable
USB cable
User documentation
Ordering Information
Colorfox VX01: P/N 90734500
Specifications
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 98 mm (3.9 in.)
110 mm (4.3 in.)
28 mm (1.1 in.)
290 g (10.2 oz.)
Control/User Interface
Touch-sensitive dial pad
Intensity select button
Color select button
Saturation select button
Playback sequence 1 - 4 select button
On/off button
161
MUM™ / DABS 1™
DABS 1 interface
MUM (Multi Utility Manager) is a handy software configurator
and programming tool for intelligent lighting products, such as
the Exterior range and the FiberSource CMY150. It automatically
recognizes supported fixtures.
The DABS 1 interface is a handy tool for uploading fixture
software from a PC base using MUM software.
Features
Features
• Windows-based configurator
with graphical interface for
stand-alone programming
• Two-way point-to-point
communication
• Read and change address,
real-time clock, light level,
stand alone settings and more
• Easy-to-understand failure
messages
• Recognizes connected fixture
automatically - no need for
set up
• Backup library of stand-alone
programs on PC
• Includes DABS 1 interface
• Upload fixture software directly
from your computer
• Compatible with Windowsbased PCs and laptops
(Windows 2000 and XP)
Specifications
Specifications
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
PHYSICAL
Supports wide range of Martin luminaires
Automatic luminaire recognition
Two-way communication with luminaire
Stores and uploads luminaire settings
Downloads luminaire information and diagnostic messages
Stand-alone show programming
Synchronized (master/slave) operation setup
DMX address setting
Intuitive graphic user interface
Free MUM software updates available from Martin website
Included DABS 1 interface can also be used for complete luminaire software uploads
MINIMUM SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS
32/64 bit and XP SP3 32 bit
64 MB RAM (128 MB recommended)
30 MB available hard disk space
CD-ROM drive
USB 1.1 (or higher) port for DABS 1 hardware interface
Laptop required for mobility at installation site
CONTROL
MUM Application
• Small and lightweight ‘go
anywhere’ solution
• 3 pin XLR connection to serial
link
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 100 mm (3.9 in.)
40 mm (1.6 in.)
40 mm (1.6 in.)
300 g (10.6 oz.)
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Color(s): Finish: Steel
Gray
Electrostatic powder-coated
CONNECTIONS
PC running MUM or Martin Software Uploader applications: Data in/out: USB
3-pin locking XLR
INCLUDED ITEMS
Installation CD: DABS 1 USB PC/fixture hardware interface:
DMX termination plug, male XLR: USB cable (A/B), 1000 mm: XLR 3-pin male to RJ-45 adapter: P/N 39200006
P/N 55758090
P/N 91613017
P/N 11840066
P/N 11840087
ORDERING INFORMATION
MUM - Multi Utility Manager incl. DABS 1 PC/Fixture Interface Device: P/N 90758090
163
Maxedia
Broadcast ™
Rackmount only
Maxedia
Pro ™
Rackmount only
Maxedia
compact ™
Rackmount only
P/N 90732590
P/N 90732580
P/N 90732570
Outputs
1x Cue + 1x Interface or 2x Cue
1x Cue + 1x Interface or 2x Cue
1x Cue + 1x Interface or 2x Cue
DMX IN
Optional P/N 90732610
Optional P/N 90732610 ArtNet IN
DMX Out







ArtNet Out
64 Universes
64 Universes
64 Universes
A/B Layers
20
20
20
Top Layers
4 per engine
4 per engine
4 per engine
Video Playback
Up to 8+ X 1080p
16 X 720p
40 X 480p
Up to 2+ X 1080p
8 X 720p
20 X 480p
Up to 4+ X 720p
20 X 720p
40 X 480p
Network Synch. Content
Network Synch. Cue






Flightcase
Optional P/N 91535060
Optional P/N 91535060
Optional P/N 91535060
In/Out Breakout Box
Optional P/N 90732610
Optional P/N 90732610
Optional P/N 90732610
Maxedia Keyboard
Drawer+keyboard
Optional P/N 91613050
Optional P/N 91613050
Optional P/N 91613050
Monitor
Not included, Elo Touch Monitor
recommended for GUI
Not included, Elo Touch Monitor
recommended for GUI
Not included, Elo Touch Monitor
recommended for GUI
Mouse
Graphical User Interface






Hard Disks
4
2
2
SATA Tray
3 (Raid + Backup)
1
1
Pixel Mapping



Effects
Full Package
Full Package
Full Package
Media Content DVD



Show Compatibility
Compatible
Compatible
Compatible
CITP Thumbnail Exchange



Video-In Capture Card
Analog
Analog
Analog
CONTROL
Part number
165
Maxedia Broadcast™
CONTROL/USER INTERFACE
M-Series/Maxedia family user interface
16 x customizable screen workspace/configurations
Touch-screen compatible user interface
Keymapping (cues and transitions assignable to keyboard keys for instant triggering)
Fixture patches identical with M-Series, can be imported from M-Series
DMX Viewer for DMX IN value reports
20 x 3D engine layers (19 user layers +1 default layer)
Static and dynamic effect presets (e.g. blending, moves)
Range of 2D and 3D plug-ins, various media
Shader and shader media
Video cue recording with 256 pages of 256 cues per show
Transitions and wipes
Output parameter adjustments, keystoning and framing
Masking
User-friendly multi-screen blending tool
Intuitive pixel mapping tool
PLAYBACK
Features
• Intuitive user interface
• State-of-the-art video engine
• Support for H.264/MPEG4 AVC, MOV and AVI HD
professional codecs
• Pixel accurate video output
• Video playback resolution up to
Full HD 1080p (Up to 8 Full HD
1080p at the same time)
• Multi-screen keystoning and
edge blending
• 20 x 3D engine layers
• 4 top layers per engine
• Dozens of effect plug-ins
• Pixel mapping for RGB and
CMY fixtures / DMX In/out
(ArtNet and DMX 512)
• Composite capture video card
included
• Support for Live HD-SDI
capture video input (optional)
• Video output configurations
(GUI + Out 1 + Out 2)
• Video playback synch between
layers and across Maxedia
servers
Video playback resolution: 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p
Video output resolution: From 1024 x 768 to 3840 x 1024*
Video output configuration: GUI + out 1 + out 2
Number of media layers: 20 each in A/B mixers (19 custom and 1 default layer)
Number of ‘top layers’ (overlay): Four per engine
Network synchronization content: Yes
Network synchronization playback: Yes
Pixel mapping (image pixel to fixture): CMY and RGB
Test pattern generator: Integrated
Master/slave networking with cue/media/timecode synchronisation
Media files in SD and HD resolution
(engine optimized for H.264/MPEG-4 AVC codec, WMV: format supported))
CONTROL
Utilizing an intuitive touchscreen-optimized user interface,
Maxedia is the most user-friendly tool for media composing
and playback in all types of applications. Access a vast library
of media clips, still images and integrated animations without
the need for a complex lighting controller. Maxedia Broadcast is
optimized for high definition playback with ultra-fast multiplecore processors, multiple 1080p playback support and two
dedicated engine outputs. Maxedia4 software is highly optimized to support H.264/MPEG-4AVC, MOV and AVI HD codecs
for superior performance and video quality.
HARDWARE
Motherboard: Processor: RAM: OS hard drive: Media hard drive: Graphics card: Capture card: Network card: High-end Intel
Multi-core Intel
4 GB high-speed
1 x high-capacity
3 x high-capacity RAID 0 plus backup
Dual ATI Radeon
1 x Composite capture card
1 x Intel Dual Gbit LAN Ethernet card
SOFTWARE
Embedded OS, Win XPe user interface
Supported media: MPEG-4, H.264, AVI with DV codec in SD quality, WMV, JPEG, BMP
Engine optimized for H.264/MPEG-4 AVC, MOV and AVI HD
Pixel mapping software for direct DMX out fixture control
Worldwide fixture library
Media Manager for media import and export
MaxNet network system for networking multiple media server and M-Series control systems
Matrox DualHead2Go- and TripleHead2Go-ready
(max. two devices per Maxedia Broadcast system)
HD capture card-ready. HD-SDI or HD-DVI 1080p, single or dual inputs,
1-2 frames maximum: latency (optional)
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 530 mm (20.9 in.)
480 mm (18.9 in.)
180 mm (7.1 in.)
25.4 kg (56.0 lbs.)
167
Maxedia Broadcast™
Maxedia Pro™
Specifications
CONNECTIONS
Rackmount version:
Computer I/O: 8 x USB, 1 x IEEE 1394 Firewire, 2 x eSATA
DMX in: Via ArtNet, optional Martin Universal USB/DMX Interface or
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface device
Remote network, ArtNet in, ArtNet out: 3 x RJ45
User display interface (VGA, 1024x768 minimum): DVI/VGA
Playback output: 2 x DVI/VGA
Digital audio: Optical digital out
Analog audio in: 3.5mm stereo mini-jack
Analog audio out: 3.5mm stereo mini-jack
Mouse: USB
Keyboard: USB
ELECTRICAL
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Approvals
EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
included items
Maxedia Media Server
Maxedia Quick Start Guide
Standard Media Library (images and videos) on 5 DVDs
Maxedia OS DVD
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC
Ordering Information
Maxedia Broadcast System RM (rackmount only): MaxModule Button: P/N 90732590
P/N 90732160
Utilizing an intuitive touchscreen-optimized user interface,
Maxedia is the most user-friendly tool for media composing
and playback in all types of applications. Access a vast library
of media clips, still images and integrated animations without
the need for a complex lighting controller. Based on a dualcore processing system, Maxedia PRO is a solid performer with
support for High Definition content playback up to two 1080p.
Two outputs are available and each can be configured as a user
interface or playback engine. The engine output can be split
over three projectors for seamless widescreen images. Maxedia
PRO supports a full pixelmapping engine for CMY and RGB
systems.
CONTROL
UL approved
EU safety:
EU EMC: Features
• Intuitive user interface
• DMX-in via Ethernet (ArtNet)
or IO-Box or Universal
USB2DMX
• 20 x 3D engine layer
• 1 top layer
• Effect plug-ins
• Pixelmapping / DMX out
(ArtNet and DMX 512)
• Video speed control
• Two video output
configurations
(Out 1 + GUI or Out 1 + Out 2)
Specifications
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 530 mm (20.9 in.)
480 mm (18.9 in.)
180 mm (7.1 in.)
25.4 kg (56.0 lbs.)
169
Maxedia Pro™
Connections
Specifications
Control/User Interface
M-Series/Maxedia family user interface
16 x customizable screen workspace/configurations
Touch-screen compatible user interface
Keymapping (cues and transitions assignable to keyboard keys for instant triggering)
Fixture patches identical with M-Series, can be imported from M-Series
DMX Viewer for DMX IN value reports
20 x 3D engine layers (19 user layers + 1 default layer)
Static and dynamic effect presets (e.g. blending, moves, effects)
Range of 2D and 3D plug-ins, various media
Shader and shader media
Video cue recording with 256 pages of 256 cues per show
Transitions and wipes
Output parameter adjustments, keystoning and framing
Masking
User-friendly multi-screen blending tool
Intuitive pixel mapping tool
Video playback resolution: 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p
Video output resolution:
From 1024 x 768 to 3840 x 1024*
Video output configurations:
Two (out 1 + GUI or out 1 + out 2)
Number of media layers: 20 each in A/B mixers (19 custom and 1 default layer)
Number of ‘top layers’ (overlay): Four per engine
Network synchronisation content: Yes
Network synchronisation playback: Yes
Pixel mapping (image pixel to fixture): CMY and RGB
Integrated test pattern generator
Master/slave networking with cue/media/timecode synchronisation
Media files in SD and HD resolution
(engine optimized for H.264/MPEG-4 AVC codec, WMV format supported)
Hardware
Motherboard: Processor: RAM: OS hard drive: Media hard drive: Graphics card: Capture card: Network card: Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Approvals
UL approved
EU safety: EU EMC: EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
Included Items
Included with rackmount version:
Maxedia Media Server
Maxedia Quick Start Guide
Standard Media Library (images and videos) on 5 DVDs
Maxedia OS DVD
Maxedia lock keys
1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC
CONTROL
Playback
Rackmount version:
Computer I/O: 8 x USB, 1 x IEEE 1394 Firewire, 2 x eSATA
DMX in: Via ArtNet, optional Martin Universal USB/DMX Interface or
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface device
Remote network, ArtNet in, ArtNet out: 3 x RJ45
User display interface (VGA, 1024x768 minimum): DVI/VGA
Playback output: DVI/VGA
Digital audio: Optical digital out
Analog audio in: 3.5mm stereo mini-jack
Analog audio out: 3.5mm stereo mini-jack
Mouse: USB
Keyboard: USB
Accessories
MCC (Maxedia Capture Card) Dual HD-SDI input card for Maxedia: P/N 90732640
MCC (Maxedia Capture Card) Dual DVI/VGA input card for Maxedia: P/N 90732630
Maxedia PCI Dual LAN card: P/N 90732650
Ordering Information
Maxedia Pro System RM (rackmount only): MaxModule Button: P/N 90732580
P/N 90732160
Intel high-end motherboard
Multi-core Intel
4 GB high-speed
1 x high-capacity
1 x high-capacity
ATI Radeon
1 x Composite/S-Video
1 x Intel Dual Gbit LAN Ethernet card
Software
Embedded OS, Win XPe user interface
Supported media:
MPEG-4, H.264, AVI with DV codec in SD quality, WMV, JPEG, BMP
Engine optimized for H.264/MPEG-4 AVC, MOV and AVI HD
Video SD format 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p:
DV-AVI (Windows or Panasonic codec),
H264 (MOV or AVI) (only from v.4)
Video HD format 720P, 1080P:
WMV-HD or BlackMagic 8-bit JPEG codec (until v.3)
H264 (MOV or AVI) (from v.4)
Still format: JPEG, BMP
Pixel mapping software for direct DMX out fixture control
Worldwide fixture library
Media Manager for media import and export
MaxNet network system for networking multiple media server and M-Series control systems
Matrox DualHead2Go- and TripleHead2Go-ready (one per Maxedia Pro system)
HD capture card-ready, HD-SDI or HD-DVI 1080p, single or dual inputs,
1-2 frames maximums latency (optinal)
171
Maxedia Compact™
Control/User Interface
M-Series/Maxedia family user interface
16 x customizable screen workspace/configurations
Touch-screen compatible user interface
Keymapping (cues and transitions assignable to keyboard keys for instant triggering)
Fixture patches identical with M-Series, can be imported from M-Series
DMX Viewer for DMX IN value reports
20 x 3D engine layers (19 user layers + 1 default layer)
Static and dynamic effect presets (e.g. blending, moves, effects)
Range of 2D and 3D plug-ins, various media
Shader and shader media
Video cue recording with 256 pages of 256 cues per show
Transitions and wipes
Output parameter adjustments, keystoning and framing
Masking
User-friendly multi-screen blending tool
Intuitive pixel mapping tool
Playback
Features
• Intuitive user interface
• State-of-the-art video engine
• Support for H.264/MPEG4 AVC, MOV and AVI HD
professional codecs
• Pixel accurate video output
• Multi-screen keystoning and
edge blending
• 20 x 3D engine layers
• 4 top layers
• Dozens of effect plug-ins
• Pixel mapping for RGB and
CMY fixtures / DMX out
(ArtNet and DMX 512)
• Composite capture video card
included
• Two video output
configurations (Out 1 + GUI or
Out 1 + Out 2)
• Video playback synch between
layers and across Maxedia
servers
Hardware
Motherboard: Processor: RAM: OS hard drive: Media hard drive: Graphics card: Capture card: Network card: High-end Intel
Multi-core Intel
2 GB high-speed
1 x high-capacity
1 x high-capacity
ATI Radeon
1 x Composite/S-Video
Onboard 2 x 1 GB LAN
Software
Embedded OS, Win XPe user interface
Supported media: MPEG-4, H.264, AVI with DV codec in SD quality, WMV, JPEG, BMP
Engine optimized for: H.264/MPEG-4 AVC, MOV and AVI HD
Pixel mapping software for direct DMX out fixture control
Worldwide fixture library
Media Manager for media import and export
MaxNet network system for networking multiple media server
and M-Series control systems
Matrox DualHead2Go- and TripleHead2Go-ready
(one per Maxedia Compact RM system)
Connections
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Video output resolution: 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p
Video output resolution: From 1024 x 768 to 3840 x 1024*
Two video output configurations (out 1 + GUI or out 1 + out 2)
Number of media layers: 19 + 1 default in each A/B mixer
Number of ‘top layers’ (overlay): 4
Network synchronisation content: Yes
Network synchronisation playback: Yes
Pixel mapping (image pixel to fixture): CMY and RGB
Integrated test pattern generator
Master/slave networking with cue/media/timecode synchronisation
Media files in SD and HD resolution: (engine optimized for H.264/MPEG-4 AVC codec,
WMV: format supported)
CONTROL
Utilizing an intuitive touchscreen-optimized user interface,
Maxedia is the most user-friendly tool for media composing and
playback in all types of applications. Access a vast library of
media clips, still images and integrated animations without the
need for a complex lighting controller.
Maxedia Compact Rackmount™ is a budget-minded solution
with slightly reduced features. Up to twenty layers of SD and HD
video media can be placed into a cue and it contains the same
amount of content as Maxedia PRO for immediate results. Pixel
mapping is possible with Maxedia Compact RM”. This is an ideal
package for installations, productions and rental companies as
it is mounted in a small 2U rack housing.
540 mm (21.3 in.)
482 mm (19.0 in.)
88 mm (3.5 in.)
13.2 kg (29.1 lbs.)
Computer I/O: DMX out: Storage media/hardware/network/video: Remote network, Ether2DMX out: User display interface (VGA, 1024x768 minimum): Digital audio: Analogue audio in: Analogue audio out: Keyboard: Mouse: 6 x USB
2 x 5-pin female locking XLR
6 x USB
2 x RJ45
DVI/VGA
SPDIF coax
3.5mm stereo mini-jack
3.5mm stereo mini-jack
PS2
PS2
173
Maxedia Compact™
Maxedia Capture card™
Specifications
Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Approvals
UL approved
EU safety: EU EMC: EN 60950
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3
Included Items
Maxedia Compact RM Media Server
Maxedia Quick Start Guide
Standard Media Library (images and videos) on 5 DVDs
Maxedia OS DVD1.5 m (4.9 ft.) power cable, 3-pin IEC
Maxedia
Video Input Device
Ordering Information
P/N 90732570
P/N 90732610
P/N 91613040
P/N 91535060
P/N 91613050
P/N 90732160
The MCC series (Maxedia Capture Card) are low latency capture
cards used in the Maxedia PRO and Maxedia Broadcast, offering
high definition in the highest quality and speed available today.
MCC Dual HD-SDI input card for Maxedia
• Low latency capture card
for the Maxedia PRO and
Broadcast range from Rev C
and up
• SD-SDI & HD-SDI compatible
(SMPTE 259M-C and SMPTE
292)
• 480i, 576i, 720P and 1080i
compatible
• 25fps, 29,97fps, 30fps, 50fps,
59,94fps and 60fps
• Every input can have a different
resolution and frame rate while
capturing
• Auto detect of the input
resolution at startup of the
Maxedia software
• Uncompressed 8-bit digital
video capture 4:2:2
• Cable equalization on both
inputs for 270 Mbit/s - 1.485
Gbit/s signals on BNC coaxial
cable
CONTROL
Maxedia Compact Rackmount System:
Maxedia I/O Breakout Box 19”: Centronic cable for Maxedia I/O Breakout Box: Maxedia Flightcase: Maxedia Keyboard Drawer with Keyboard:
MaxModule Button: MCC Dual DVI/VGA input card for Maxedia
• Low latency capture card
for the Maxedia PRO and
Broadcast range from Rev C
and up
• DVI-D (digital)/DVI-A (analog
RGBHV) 640 x 480, up to
1920x1080 pixels
• HDMI 480i/p, 576i/p, 720P &
1080i
• Built-in EDID per input
switchable between Analog
and Digital (Maxedia software
4.x required)
• Every input can have a different
resolution and frame rate while
capturing
• Adaptive equalizer for cable
lengths up to 30 meters
(by using quality cable)
• DVI 1.0 and HDMI 1.3 single
link compliant. No HDCP
digital content protection
support
• VGA-to-DVI & HDMI-to-DVI
connections possible through
standard adapters (not
provided)
175
Martin ShowDesigner™
Live video input for screen, static and moving video projector simulation
Pan/tilt of beams, indexed and rotating gobos, iris effects, color wheels,
CMY color mixing, shutter/dimmer/strobe, zoom, color scrolling, framing system
Gobo editor
Cuelist for direct playback
DMX viewer monitors inbound and outbound data
Photo-realistic rendering
IES to MSD fixture profile converter
Light metre tool calculates light level on surface
Playback
Show preview using simple playback
Offline program for real-time monitoring of 3D light setup
Minimum System Requirements
Features
• 3D Graphic engine delivers
stunning real-time quality
rendering
• Fixture beams show true-life
light distribution
• Import of 2D and 3D AutoCAD
DXF files
• Fixture library covers most
manufacturers and fixtures
• Photometric calculations
• Ray-tracing including shadows,
reflections, transparency,
smoke
• Net-Render server/client tool
• Camera animation using
intuitive time-line control
• Real time video input
• Connects to any DMX
controller for offline
programming
Specifications
Control and Programming
Control of all fixture parameters
Programming and storage of cues
Cues contain basic timing and link information
User-customizable fixture libraries
(complete range of Martin and other fixture definitions included)
User-customizable object libraries
Free fixture and objects library updates
Fixtures automatically patched to free DMX address
Paperwork utility prints plot and equipment list
Solid rendering of scenes
Texture editor
Features below available in GOLD version only
Real-time solid beam 3D Visualizer, uses DMX or video input to give visualization
of following effects
Recommended
Windows XP/Vista/7 (32-bit or 64-bits)
Dual Core or Quad Core processor
2+ GB RAM
500 MB available hard disc space
SVGA card, true (24-bit) color, minimum 1024x768 resolution, hardware accelerated,
512 MB VRAM, DirectX support (ATI and NVIDIA are recommended)
CD-ROM drive
USB 1.1 (or higher) port for dongle
USB 1.1 (or higher) port if Martin Universal USB/DMX Interface or
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface is used
Network card required for communication with other controller or Ethernet box
via LAN (Artnet, Maxxyz, M-Series, Compulite, Avolite, Hog, MA)
Full administrator rights on PC
CONTROL
Martin ShowDesigner (MSD) is a unique and user-friendlylighting and set design software package, brilliant for
developing realistic 3-D lighting simulations. Invaluable as
a high quality production or sales presentation tool, MSD
allows you to create realistic set and lighting design renderings
using reflection, transparency, lighting, shadow and smoke.
Acquire and upgrade ShowDesigner packages online at
www.martinshowdesigner.com
Windows XP/Vista (32-bit OS)
Pentium 4 CPU
1 GB RAM
400 MB available hard disc space
SVGA card, high (32-bit) color, 1024x768 resolution
CD-ROM drive
USB 1.1 (or higher) port for dongle
USB 1.1 (or higher) port if Martin Universal USB/DMX Interface or
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface is used
Network card required for communication with other controller or Ethernet box
via LAN (Artnet, Maxxyz, M-Series, Compulite, Avolite, Hog, MA)
Full administrator rights on PC
Connections
Connects to any controller that has DMX output (Martin Universal USB/DMX
Interface or Martin USB Duo DMX Interface required) or Artnet output
Connects to other controller or Ethernet box via LAN (Maxxyz via Artnet, Compulite, Avolite)
Connects to various applications using internal driver (Martin LightJockey,
Martin Proscenium, HogPC, Sandnet, Horizon...)
Fast Net Render (GOLD only) allows networked rendering across multiple Windows-based PCs
Environment
Artnet-compatible DMX distribution
Supports Martin Universal USB/DMX Interface and Martin USB Duo DMX Interface
Compatible with Maxxyz, M-Series and M-PC
DXF, Sketchup, XFile 2D and 3D file import
Included Items
Martin ShowDesigner software package CD
Martin ShowDesigner USB dongle
Installation instructions
Quick Start guide
Ordering Information
Order from Martin:
MSD 5 Gold: MSD 5 Live: MSD 5 Live 4: P/N 90756057
P/N 90756058
P/N 90756059
Or order online from www.martinshowdesigner.co
177
MSD5 Gold™
MSD5 Live™
MSD5 Live 4™
MSD5 Live LJ™
MSD5 MC Edition™
activated
MSD5 MC Edition™
Demo
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Modeler
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
3D Visualizer
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Paper
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
DMX Monitor
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
Fast NetRender
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
Fixture Library
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Object Library
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Real-time 3D
Rendering
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
DMX Connectivity
Several Drivers
Several Drivers
Several Drivers
LightJockey
LightJockey Maxxyz
LightJockey Maxxyz
Supported DMX
Universes
64
64
4
4
64
2
Dynamic Scenery
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
Video Input
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
Lighting Cues
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
Monitoring DMX
Levels
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
DXF Import
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
PC VectorWorks
import
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
DMX Record &
Playback
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
Video Creation
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
Fixed text on
Screen
No
No
No
No
No
Yes
Subscription
reminder
No
No
No
No
No
Every 30 min
Save Changes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Usage Period
Unlimited
Unlimited
Unlimited
Unlimited
1 year (45 days trial)
Unlimited
P/N
90756057
90756058
90756059
(Online purchase only
www.martinshowdesigner.com)
N/A
N/A
CONTROL
ShowDesigner
179
Ether2DMX8™
Control/User Interface
Front panel display with 4-button control menu
1 x dual-color LED per port
Mouse & keyboard input
Remote web access
DMX viewer for any physical incoming or outgoing DMX port
Hardware
Features
• Artnet to DMX conversion
• DMX to Artnet conversion
• 10 Factory Presets
• 10 User Presets
• 99 Cues with Fade Time, Hold
Time and Cue Linking
• 8 Switch Inputs
• 8 XLR female 5pins
• DMX Monitor
• DMX and Artnet Test
Generator
• Multiple Artnet IP in for backup
system
• USB port for backup and
firmware updates
• M1 Extension with 8x DMX512
• M-PC License with 8x DMX512
10 user presets for device configuration
M-Series/Maxedia use preset with auto-IP address setting
Presets for DMX Hub and Spitter functionality
Mergeable setup where multiple inputs are routed in LTP, HTP to one output
Ports assignable to input or output
Ports routable to/from internal ports or to/from any DMX universe on Artnet
Port routing triggerable by contact closure through the use of user presets
Ports’ DMX channel ranges configurable
Merger modules routable between inputs & outputs and/or Artnet universes
Channel ranges can be put in LTP/HTP, copy or fixed value from other channels
Auto or manual IP addressing
Tracking backup function: automatic handover to another Artnet signal if one Artnet signal fails
DMX and Artnet test pattern generator
Artnet broadcast and unicast compatible
Configuration files loadable/storable on USB memory sticks
Firmware upload via USB memory stick
Construction
Housing: Finish: Installation
19-inch rackmount (1U)
Steel and aluminum
Electrostatic powder-coated
Connections
10/100 base-T ethernet port: DMX in/out ports: Keyboard: Mouse: Backup, software upload: Monitor: AC power input: AC power throughput: Specifications
Neutrik locking RJ45 Ethercon socket
8 x 5-pin female XLR
USB or PS2
USB or PS2
USB
VGA 15-pin
3-pin IEC male socket
3-pin IEC female socket
Electrical
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Weight: Software
CONTROL
Ether2DMX8 is a highly capable DMX router and much more!
As a DMX router, it translates Artnet protocol into DMX in/out
universes but can also be used as a DMX merger, DMX splitter
hub, fail safe device, cue playback, and DMX viewer monitor. As
an extension for the M1 console it provides 8 additional DMX
ports and includes the required DMX license. When connected
to a standalone PC, the Ether2DMX8 also becomes the license
key for M-PC and provides 8 DMX Universes.
520 MHz processor for fast, synchronized DMX output, latency virtually zero
Ethernet:
Artnet-compliant, Artnet II-compliant
ACN-ready
Built-in webpage for quick access and remote setup
10/100 Mbit connection
8 ports:
Configurable as input or output
Opto-isolated circuit for each port
User-definable DMX timings for each port
Each port set as output can be set to constantly repeat the last received DMX frame,
or only to output new frames
RDM-ready
Dual-color LED for each port
8 open-contact inputs:
Inputs transmit ArtNet-compatible contact closures on the network
Contact closures can trigger factory and user presets and start cue playback
288 mm (11.3 in.)
482.2 mm (19.0 in.), 19-inch rackmount
43.6 mm (1.7 in.),1U
3.6 kg (7.9 lbs.)
AC power: Main fuse: Auto-ranging 100 - 240 VAC nominal, 50/60 Hz
2 x 500 mA T (slow-blow)
Ordering Information
Ether2DMX8: P/N 90758130
181
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Weight: 103 mm (4.1 in.)
73 mm (2.9 in.)
42 mm (1.7 in.)
116 g (4.1 oz.)
Control/User Interface
Configuration and management: Application (e.g. LightJockey, M-PC, Maxedia, Maxxyz, M1)
Device status: 3 x red/orange/green LEDs
Connections
DMX data: PC/controller:
2 x 5-pin locking XLR, both configurable for DMX in/out
USB
Electrical
USB-powered
Included Items
3 m (9.8 ft.) USB cable
CD with drivers and installation/user documentation
Ordering Information
Martin USB Duo DMX Interface:
P/N 90703010
CONTROL
The Martin USB Duo DMX Interface features XLR 5P female
connectors and provides two DMX 512 universes from any
USB enabled Windows-based PC. It communicates with Martin
LightJockey, the Maxxyz and M1 controller series, the Maxedia
media server series, and Martin ShowDesigner 5 (MSD5), as
well as Martin fixture software uploaders (not compatible with
MUM software).
Features
• Plug and play solution: comes
complete with XLR adapters,
USB cable and installation
notes
• 2 DMX universes configurable for in/out
• Convenient, space-saving
stackable design
• Easily mounts to surfaces and
walls
• DMX 512-A (RDM compatible)
• Upload of fixture software files
(MU3)
• Activates 2 DMX Universes in
M-PC Demo Mode
183
Martin DMX 5.3 Splitter™
AC power input: 1.2 m (3.9 ft.) cable tail with US-type (NEMA-5-15) power plug
Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Power supply unit: Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
Typical total power consumption:
4W
Power consumption figures are typical, not maximum. Allow for +/-10% variation.
Thermal
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 55° C (131° F)
-30° C (-22° F)
Approvals
Features
• DMX Splitter / Booster
• Opto-isolated DMX Output
ports
• DMX loop through port with
built-in termination
• 3-pin XLR Input and Outputs
• Optimized for Martin fixture
firmware upload
• Universal power supply
• Rack, truss and wall mountable
• Lightweight yet robust
construction
EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2
UL 508
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 14
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Included Items
4 x screws to join two devices for rack mounting
2 x L-brackets + 8 x screws for 19-inch rack mounting two Splitters (1U)
or surface mounting
1.2 m (3.9 ft.) (3.9 ft.) hard-wired power cable with US-type (NEMA-5-15) plug
Accessories
alf-coupler clamp: H
G-clamp: Quick trigger clamp: Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): 3-pin male XLR to 5-pin female XLR adaptor: 5-pin male XLR to 3-pin female XLR adaptor: 5-pin male XLR to male RJ-45 adapter: 5-pin female XLR to male RJ-45 adapter: P/N 91602005
P/N 91602003
P/N 91602007
P/N 91604003
P/N 11820004
P/N 11820005
P/N 11840111
P/N 11840112
CONTROL
The Martin DMX 5.3 Splitter is the most economical protection
for DMX controllers and devices. The main purpose of the
Martin 5.3 Splitter is to maintain proper data over long or several
runs of DMX signal. The Splitter boosts the weak DMX signal
to its original output level before it becomes too low to be read
from DMX devices. Disruption of DMX is often caused by bad
cables or bad connections. The Martin DMX 5.3 Splitter will
help to rectify the signal.
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: Ordering Information
Martin DMX 5.3 Splitter: P/N 90758140
Specifications
Physical
Depth: Width: Height: Weight: 125 mm (4.9 in.)
220 mm (8.7 in.)
45 mm (1.8 in.)
0.9 kg (2.0 lbs.)
Data signal
DMX: Electrical standard: Recommended cable type: Recommended cable gauge:
ANSI E1.11 (USITT DMX 512-A)
EIA-485
STP (Shielded Twisted Pair)
22 or 24 AWG
Construction
Housing: Finish: Aluminum
Electrostatic powder-coated
Connections
Data input: Data throughput (not amplified or branched): Data outputs (optically isolated and amplified): 3-pin XLR male
3-pin XLR female
5 x 3-pin XLR female
185
Martin RDM 5.5 Splitter™
Data outputs (optically isolated and amplified): AC power input:
AC power throughput: 5 x 5-pin XLR female
Neutrik PowerCon
Neutrik PowerCon
Electrical
AC power: 100-240 V nominal, 50/60 Hz
Power supply unit: Auto-ranging electronic switch-mode
Typical total power consumption: 4W
Power consumption figures are typical, not maximum. Allow for +/-10% variation.
Thermal
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Minimum ambient temperature (Ta min.): 55° C (131° F)
-30° C (-22° F)
Approvals
Features
• DMX Splitter / Booster
• Opto-isolated DMX Output
ports
• DMX loop through port with
built-in termination
• 5-pin XLR Input and Outputs
• RDM E1.20 compliant
• Optimized for Martin fixture
firmware upload
• Universal power supply
• PowerCon connectors in/out
for easy daisy-chaining
• Rack, truss and wall mountable
• Lightweight yet robust
construction
EN 60950-1
EN 55022, EN 55024, EN 55103-1, EN 55103-2
UL 508
FCC Part 15 Class A
CAN/CSA C22.2 No. 14
ICES-003 Class A
C-TICK N4241
Included Items
4 x screws to join two devices for rack mounting
2 x L-brackets + 8 x screws for 19-inch rack mounting two Splitters (1U) or
surface mounting
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA male input connector
Accessories
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCA power input connector, cable mount, blue: P/N 05342804
Neutrik PowerCon NAC3FCB power output connector, cable mount, light grey: P/N 05342805
Half-coupler clamp: P/N 91602005
G-clamp: P/N 91602003
Quick trigger clamp: P/N 91602007
Safety wire, safe working load 50 kg (110.2 lbs.): P/N 91604003
3-pin male XLR to 5-pin female XLR adaptor: P/N 11820004
5-pin male XLR to 3-pin female XLR adaptor: P/N 11820005
5-pin male XLR to male RJ-45 adapter: P/N 11840111
5-pin female XLR to male RJ-45 adapter: P/N 11840112
CONTROL
The Martin RDM 5.5 Splitter is the perfect companion to any
controller or DMX/RDM device. The main purpose of the Martin
5.5 Splitter is to maintain proper data over long or several runs
of DMX signal. The Splitter boosts the weak DMX signal to its
original output level before it becomes too low to be read by
DMX devices. Disruption of DMX is often caused by bad cables
or bad connections. The Martin RDM 5.5 Splitter will help to
rectify the signal.
EU safety: EU EMC: US safety: US EMC: Canadian safety: Canadian EMC: Australia/NZ: Ordering Information
Martin RDM 5.5 Splitter: P/N 90758150
Specifications
Physical
Depth: Width: Height: Weight: 125 mm (4.9 in.)
220 mm (8.7 in.)
45 mm (1.8 in.)
0.9 kg (2.0 lbs.)
Data signal
DMX: RDM: Electrical standard: Recommended cable type: Recommended cable gauge: ANSI E1.11 (USITT DMX 512-A)
ANSI E1.20
EIA-485
STP (Shielded Twisted Pair)
22 or 24 AWG
Construction
Housing: Finish: Aluminum
Electrostatic powder-coated
Connections
Data input: Data throughput (not amplified or branched): 5-pin XLR male
5-pin XLR female
187
ATMOSPHERIC
EFFECTS
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Jem Glaciator X-Stream
Jem Roadie X-Stream
Jem Roadie Compact
Jem Hydra
Jem ZR44 Hi-Mass
Jem K1 Hazer
Jem Compact Hazer Pro
Jem AF-1
Jem AF-2
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Magnum 2500 Hz
Magnum 2000
Magnum 1800
Magnum 1200
Magnum 850
Magnum 650
Magnum Club Smoke
• Fluid Matrix & Machine Application chart
• Fluids
• Accessories
189
Jem Roadie
Compact ™
Jem Glaciator
X-Stream ™
Jem ZR44 Hi-Mass ™
Jem Hydra ™
Jem Compact
Hazer Pro™
Jem K1 Hazer ™
Continuous output
Yes 
Yes 
Yes
YesYesYes
Density
Density control: low, medium or high
Output and density level
control
Output control
Output control
Output and density level
Output and density level
controlcontrol
Output
80 m3/min fog output  
2500 m3/min fog output   700 m3/min fog output (per head)
1200 m3/min fog output  
5000 m3/min haze output  
3800 m3/min haze output
Speed
–
Integrated high velocity fan
–
Integrated high velocity fan
(variable fan speed)
Integrated high velocity fan
(variable fan speed)
Heat Exchange
3500 W heat exchanger
2 x 1500 W heat exchanger
1500 W heat exchanger
1800 W heat exchanger 
600 W heat exchanger 
900 W heat exchanger
Heat-up time
15 min heat-up time  
9 min heat-up time   
9 min heat-up time
7.5 min heat-up time
5 min heat-up time
60 sec heat-up time
For vertical or horizontal
effect projection 
Can be mounted in any
direction
Floor standing or truss mounting
Floor standing or flying kit
 Floor standing or flying kit
HEAT EXCHANGE
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
OUTPUT
MOUNTING
Mounting
Floor Standing Only
FLUID
Capacity
5 liter fluid capacity 
9.5 liter fluid capacity  2 x 25 liter fluid capacity
9.5 liter fluid capacity 
2.5 liter fluid capacity 
2.5 liter fluid capacity
Low-Fluid
Low fluid sensing 
Low fluid sensing   Low fluid sensing
Indirect fluid sensing system
for unattended operation Low fluid consumption and longer
hang-time for greater economy Low fluid consumption and long
hang-time
Options
Different fluid options for
different applications
Different fluid options for
different applications
Temperature control for different
fluid options and applications
Different fluid options for
different applications
–
-
Supply
Internal or external fluid supply  Internal Supply 
Automatic tank changeover
Internal supply
Water based - no oil residue on light fixtures Internal supply
sealed for transport
Self contained unit: no C02 or dry ice –
Leak detection system –
–
Automated shut-down procedure to prevent clogging -
Optional self-sealed
connectors for easy service
RDM Capable
–
-
Onboard DMX, 3 & 5 pin  
Onboard DMX, 3 & 5 pin 
Onboard DMX, 5 pin
–
Pre-programmedstand-alone macros
SAFETY
Service
MAINTENANCE
Service
–
–
CONTROL
Control
Onboard DMX
Onboard DMX, 3 & 5 pin
System is DMX controllable
Macros
–
Pre-programmedPre-programmed
stand-alone macros
stand-alone macros
Onboard control panel
Yes
Yes
Yes
Removable onboard Yes
Yes
Options
Optional ducting system
–
–
Removable panel for remote
analogue remote control
Fast access set-up mode
Optional air director
Remote
Optional hand-held remote
control
Optional multifunctional
remote control
Optional multifunctional
remote control
Optional multifunctional 
Optional digital
Optional digital 
remote control
remote control
multifunctional remote control
Although not represented in the chart above, the Jem Roadie X-Stream is still a current model.
191
Magnum
2000 ™
Magnum
Club Smoke™
Magnum
2500 Hz ™
Magnum
1800 ™
Magnum
1200 ™
Magnum
850 ™
Magnum
650 ™
Continuous output
–
Yes 
Density
Output control Output control
Output
Yes
Yes
Output control
Output control
Output control
Output control
700 m3/min fog 550 m3/min fog 2500 m3/min haze
output outputoutput
Speed
–
–
Yes
Yes
–
–
580 m3/min fog   
290 m3/min fog 200 m3/min fog 160 m3/min fog
output output outputoutput
– – ––
HEAT EXCHANGE
Heat Exchange
1600 W  
1000 W 900 W
1000 W 850 W 
750 W 600 W
Heat-up time
8 minutes 
7 minutes
6-8 minutes
9 minutes
8 minutes
8 minutes
7 minutes 
Floor standing or 
truss mounting
Truss mounting
Floor standing
Floor standing/Truss mount Floor standing/Truss mount
with optional flying kit
with optional flying kit
Floor standing
Floor standing 
–
–
Optional flying kit
Optional flying kit
–
–
1 liter fluid capacity
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
OUTPUT
MOUNTING
Mounting
Stand–
FLUID
Capacity
9.5 liter fluid capacity  
10 liter fluid capacity 
3.8 liter fluid capacity
3.8 liter fluid capacity  
2.3 liter fluid capacity 
1 liter fluid capacity
Low-Fluid
– 
Low fluid sensing 
–
–
–
––
Options
Different fluid Different fluid
options for different options for different
applicationsapplications
-
Different fluid Different fluid Different fluid Different fluid
options for different options for different
options for different
options for different
applications applications applicationsapplications
Supply
Internal supply Internal supply
Internal supply
Internal supply
Internal supply
Internal supply
Control
Optional DMX Onboard DMX 
Optional DMX
Onboard DMX 
Optional DMX  
–
–
Onboard control panel
Yes– –
––
–
–
Options
Removable panel for 
–
–
remote control
Internal remote
control storage
Internal remote
control storage
–
–
Remote
Timer and output level remote control
Timer and output level remote control
Timer and output
level remote control
Timer and output
level remote control
Hard-wired single button
Internal supply
CONTROL
Multifunctional
remote control
Timer and output
level remote control
193
Jem Glaciator X-Stream™
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: Compatible remote controls: DMX channels: Protocol: Onboard control panel, onboard DMX
For limited control
2 (Output and Compressor)
USITT DMX512/1990
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
3500 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
Oscillating piston, high pressure X2
Internal 5 l reservoir
For larger volume remote fluid supply
120 ml per minute
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Floor mount only (On wheels)
Connection
Remote control: DMX data:
Power cable entry:
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin locking XLR
IEC-EN60309-2 Socket (Cee Type)
ELECTRICAL
The Jem Glaciator X-Stream creates a total ground fog effect
from a self-contained unit. It utilizes the simple but effective
Jem heavy fog fluids and a closed loop refrigeration system for
an easy-to-produce heavy fog solution.
220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
Onboard 32 A Breaker
208 V, 60 Hz
Onboard 32 A Breaker
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
Features
• Density control: low, medium or high
• Continuous output
• 80 m²/min fog output
• 3500 W heat exchanger
• 15 min heat-up time
• 5 liter fluid capacity
• Different fluid options for different applications
AC power (EU models): Main fuse (220-240 V power):
AC power (US models): Main fuse (208 V power):
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: External fluid supply: Fluid consumption at peak output: • Internal or external fluid supply
• Low fluid sensing
• Self contained unit: no C02 or dry ice
• Onboard DMX
• Onboard control panel
• Optional ducting system
EU safety: EU safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
ACCESSORIES
Heavy Fog (B2 mix) fluid
Heavy Fog (C3 mix) fluid
Jem Multi-function (Analogue) Remote Control:
Ducting Kit incl. twin adapter and 2 x 5 m ducting:
P/N 92765013
P/N 92625007
ORDERING INFORMATION
Jem Glaciator X-Stream, 240 V:
Jem Glaciator X-Stream, 208 V:
P/N 92210500
P/N 92210501
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Coverage volume: Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): 866 mm (34.1 in.)
638 mm (25.1 in.)
725 mm (28.5 in.)
110 kg (242.5 lbs.)
80 m² per minute
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
15 minutes
195
Jem Roadie X-Stream™
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: Compatible remote controls: DMX channels: Protocol: Onboard control panel, onboard DMX
For limited control
2 (output and fan)
USITT DMX512/1990
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
2 x 2500 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: Oscillating piston, high pressure X4
2 x 9.5 l
500 ml per minute
Orientation: Floor or flying kit
Connection
Remote control: DMX data:
Power cable entry:
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin locking XLR
IEC-EN60309-2 Socket (Cee Type)
ELECTRICAL
The Jem Roadie X-Stream blends fog and air to produce a variety
of effects; from an optically translucent haze to an immensely
dense “white-out” of fog.
AC power: Main fuse (208-240 V power):
208 V 60 Hz / 220 - 240 V 50 Hz
Onboard 25 A Breaker
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
included items
Features
• Output and density level control
• Continuous output
• 5000 m3/min fog output
• Integrated high velocity fan
• 2 x 2500 W heat exchanger
• 18 min heat-up time
• For vertical or horizontal effect projection
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
INSTALLATION
• 2 x 9.5 liter fluid capacity
• Different fluid options for different applications
• Low fluid sensing
• Onboard DMX
• Onboard control panel
• Optional hand-held remote control
Container 9.5 l x 2:
´C´ form female socket for use with own power cable:
P/N 34300528
P/N 05327240
ACCESSORIES
Pro Smoke Studio (DX Mix) fluid
Pro Steam Simulation (AA) fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke High Density (SP Mix) fluid
Regular DJ (DJ mix) fluid
Pro Haze (Haze mix) fluid
I-fog fluid
Jem Roadie X-Stream Remote Control:
P/N 92765025
ORDERING INFORMATION
Jem Roadie X-Stream:
P/N 92230400
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): 1140 mm (44.9 in.)
645 mm (25.4 in.)
655 mm (25.8 in.)
167 kg (368.2 lbs.)
5000 m3 per minute
108 minutes
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
18 minutes
197
Jem Roadie Compact™
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: Compatible remote controls: DMX channels: Protocol: Onboard control panel, onboard DMX
For limited control
2 (output and fan)
USITT DMX512/1990
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
2 x 1500 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: Oscillating piston, high pressure X2
9.5 l
220 ml per minute
Orientation: Floor mount (Horizontal or vertical) or flying kit
Connection
Remote control: DMX data:
Power cable entry:
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin and 5-pin XLR sockets
Hard-wired
ELECTRICAL
Martin’s industry-standard Jem Roadie X-Stream is available in
a high-output, compact version that makes big-time fog and
haze effects even more manageable.
AC power: Main fuse (208-240 V power):
208 V 60 Hz / 220 - 240 V 50 Hz
Onboard 16 A Breaker
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
included items
Features
• Output and density level control
• Continuous output
• 2500 m3/min fog output
• Integrated high velocity fan
• 2 x 1500 W heat exchanger
• 9 min heat-up time
• For vertical or horizontal effect projection
• 9.5 liter fluid capacity
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
INSTALLATION
• Different fluid options for different applications
• Low fluid sensing
• Onboard DMX, 3 & 5 pin
• Pre-programmed stand-alone macros
• Onboard control panel
• Optional multifunctional
remote control
Container 9.5 l:
Hard wired mains cable 2 m (6.6 ft.) Flying kit
P/N 34300528
ACCESSORIES
Pro Smoke Studio (DX Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke High Density (SP Mix) fluid
Pro Steam Simulation (AA) fluid
Regular DJ (DJ mix) fluid
I-fog fluid
Pro Haze fluid
Jem Multi-Function (Digital) Remote Control:
Ducting Kit:
P/N 92765026
P/N 92625010
ORDERING INFORMATION
Jem Roadie Compact:
P/N 92230500
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.):
800 mm (31.5 in.)
500 mm (19.7 in.)
600 mm (23.6 in.)
80 kg (176.4 lbs.)
2500 m3 per minute
90 minutes
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
9 minutes
199
Jem Hydra™
DMX channels: Protocol: Optional digital remote control:
1 per head, maximum 16
USITT DMX512/1990
For limited control
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
1500 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
Fluid pump: Low pressure pump in Base Unit supplies constant 2.5 bar pressure
Pump (EP5) in Head Unit increases 2.5 bar inlet pressure to 16 bar
Solenoid valve in Head Unit for instant cut-off
Onboard fluid capacity: 2 x 25 l
Fluid consumption at peak output: 120 ml per minute per head
Orientation (Head): Orientation (Base): Any
Floor mount only (On wheels)
ELECTRICAL
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): The Jem Hydra is a multi-headed fog generator which gives
you total flexibility in fog placement through a maximum of 16
individually DMX controlled output heads, all serviced by one
centralized base.
• Central base allows heads to be positioned up to 300 meters apart
• Continuous output
• 700 m3/min fog output (per head)
• 1500 W heat exchanger
• 2 x 25 liter fluid capacity
• Temperature control for different fluid options and applications
• Automatic tank changeover
• Low fluid sensing
Specifications
• Leak detection system
• Optional self-sealed connectors for easy service
• System is DMX controllable
• Pre-programmed stand-alone macros
• Onboard control panel
• Optional multifunctional remote
control
• Produces high quality CO2
effect with our special
formulated Pro Stream
Simulation fluid
• Create variable smoke output
PHYSICAL
Length (Head): Width (Head): Height (Head): Dry Weight (Head): Length (Base): Width (Base): Height (Base): Dry weight (Base): PERFORMANCE
440 mm (17.3 in.)
392 mm (15.4 in.)
167 mm (6.6 in.)
13.8 kg (30.4 lbs.)
664 mm (26.1 in.)
392 mm (15.4 in.)
939 mm (37.0 in.)
35 kg (77.2 lbs.) incl. two empty 25 l drums
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): 700 m3 per minute per head
60 minutes (full 16-head system)
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
9 minutes
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state:
Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: Features
220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
INcluded items
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
INSTALLATION
Hard wired mains cable 2 m (6.6 ft.) (head)
M8 x 13 mm (0.5 in.) safety eye (head): P/N 08131901
Fluid line ‘tee’ piece 10 mm (0.4 in.) x 10 mm (0.4 in.) x6 mm (0.2 in.) (head): P/N 26460790
Fluid line 6 mm (0.2 in.) x 10 m (32.8 ft.) (head): P/N 62520020
Container 25 l (x2): P/N 34300529
Fluid line 10 mm (0.4 in.) x 30 m (98.4 ft.) (x2): P/N 14026021
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug: P/N 11501012
Blanking plug 10 mm (0.4 in.) push In: P/N 26460740
Terminator, 3 pin male hydra: P/N 56250080
Terminator, 3 pin female hydra: P/N 56250090
ACCESSORIES
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke High Density (SP Mix) fluid
Regular DJ (DJ mix) fluid
Pro Steam Simulation (AA) fluid
Pro Smoke Studio (DX Mix) fluid
I-fog fluid
Digital Multi-function Remote Control:
Hydra Termination Plug (Male):
Hydra Termination Plug (Female):
Self-seal connector, 2 x 6 mm m/f, valved:
Self-seal connector, 2 x 10 mm m/f, valved:
30 m length of 10 mm tubing:
Straight-through connector, 2 x 10 mm:
P/N 92765026
P/N 56250080
P/N 56250090
P/N 92620007
P/N 92620008
P/N 92620010
P/N 92620009
ORDERING INFORMATION
Jem Hydra Base Unit, 110 V: Jem Hydra Base Unit, 240 V: Jem Hydra Head Unit, 110 V: Jem Hydra Head Unit, 240 V: Jem Hydra 1.8, 110V: Jem Hydra 1.16, 110V: Jem Hydra 1.4, 110V: P/N 92250300
P/N 92250200
P/N 92250500
P/N 92250400
P/N 92251050
P/N 92251150
P/N 92251250
Onboard control panel, onboard DMX
Instant or timer-controlled variable output
Output is proportional for all levels above 12%
201
Jem ZR44 Hi-Mass™
Specifications
Performance
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.)
Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.):
1200 m 3
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
7.5 minutes
Control and Programming
Construction
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
1800 W, direct thermal protection
Fluid System
The Jem ZR44 Hi-Mass is a reliable and highly efficient fogger
capable of precise fog delivery from subtle to massive. Ideal
for a variety of settings from small venues to huge stadiums
and arenas, it features advanced technology for top-quality
performance, as well as advances in digital functionality such
as RDM compatibility.
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: Oscillating piston, high pressure X2
9.5 l
150 ml per minute
Installation
Orientation: Floor or adjustable mounting bracket
Connections
PRemote control: DMX and RDM data in/out: Power cable entry: 2 x 3-pin locking XLR
2 x 3-pin and 2 x 5-pin locking XLR
Neutrik PowerCon
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Control options: Onboard analogue remote control (Supplied),
Multi-Function digital remote Control options: control (Optional),
DMX (3 and 5 pin), 0-10V analog, RDM capable
Remote control features:
Instant or timer-controlled variable output
Delay time 2-144 seconds, run time 2-144 seconds
DMX channels:
1
RDM Capable:
via DMX socket
Digital link machine to machine (Using optional Digital Multi-Function remote)
Electrical
Features
• 1200 m³/min fog output
• Continuous output
• 1800 W heat exchanger
• 7.5 min heat-up time
• Floor standing or truss
mounting
• Neutrik PowerCon connector
• Indirect Fluid Sensing System
• Proprietary Pro Steam
Simulation fluid solution
• Different fluid options for
different applications
• Leaves no oil residue on light
fixtures
• Tough and solid design
• 3 & 5 pin DMX interface
• Prepared for multifunctional
digital remote
• RDM capable
• Soft Start technology
220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
10 A
20 A
Thermal
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
Approvals
ETL approvals (cETLus) pending
Included items
Remote control
Container 9.5 l: P/N 34300528
Accessories
Pro Smoke Studio (DX Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke High Density (SP Mix) fluid
Pro Steam Simulation (AA) fluid
I-fog fluid
Regular DJ (DJ mix) fluid
Digital Multi-function Remote Control:
P/N 92765037
Ducting Kit incl. adapter and 5 m (16.4 ft.) of 4-inch (104mm)ducting: P/N 92625005
Drip Tray Kit: P/N 92620011
Specifications
Ordering Information
Physical
Length: Length (Inc Optional Drip Tray):
Width:
Height:
Dry weight:
AAC power (EU models):
AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 685 mm (27.0 in.)
750 mm (29.5 in.)
345 mm (13.6 in.)
225 mm (8.9 in.)
19 kg (41.9 lbs.)
Jem ZR44 Hi-Mass, 110V: Jem ZR44 Hi-Mass, 240V: P/N 92215310
P/N 92215300
203
Jem K1 Hazer™
Specifications
Physical
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: 544 mm (21.4 in.)
459 mm (18.1 in.)
344 mm (13.5 in.)
21.5 kg (47.4 lbs.)
Performance
Coverage volume: Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): 5000 m3 per minute
17 hours
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
5 minutes
Control and Programming
Construction
Housing: Heat exchanger: The Jem K1 Hazer is Martin’s top-of-the-line hazer for high
performance applications where a high level of reliability
and easy serviceability is required. Feature-rich and of solid
construction, the Jem K1 provides the ideal combination of
continuous operation, long hang time, and low fluid consumption
for greater economy.
• Designed for service ease
• Continuous output
• Output and density level
control
• 5000 m³/min haze output
• Integrated high velocity fan
(variable fan speed)
• 600 W heat exchanger
• 2.5 liter fluid capacity
• Low fluid consumption and
longer hang-time for greater
economy
Fluid System
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: Compatible Fluids: • Water based - no oil residue on
light fixtures
• Automated shut-down
procedure to prevent clogging
• Onboard DMX, 3 & 5 pin
• Onboard control panel
• Fast access set-up mode
• Optional digital remote control
• Silent Mode
• Eco mode extends run time and
improves fluid economy
Oscillating piston, high pressure
2.5 l
140 ml per hour
K1 Haze Fluid
Installation
Orientation: Floor or flying kit
Connections
Power connection: DMX data: Remote control: Features
Steel & aluminum
600 W, direct thermal protection
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Control options: Onboard control panel with 4-digit display
Control options: Instant or timer-controlled output, 0-100% adjustable output level
Control options: Adjustable Fan Speed Level
DMX channels: 2 (output and fan)
Optional digital remote control: 92765036
Neutrik PowerCon
3-pin and 5-pin XLR sockets
3-pin locking XLR
Electrical
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
5 AT
10 AT
Thermal
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
40° C (104° F)
200° C (392° F)
Approvals
EU EMC: EU safety: Immunity: ETL approvals (cETLus): EN 6100-6-3: 2001 - Part 6-3
EN 60 335-1: 2002
EN 61000-6-1: 2001 - Part 6-1
UL Std.998, CAN/CSA Std. C22.2 No 104-01
Accessories
Only for use with Jem K1 Haze fluid
Jem K1 Hazer Remote Control
P/N 92765036
Ordering Information
Jem K1 Hazer, 110 V
Jem K1 Hazer, 240 V
P/N 92225900
P/N 92225901
205
Jem Compact Hazer Pro™
Specifications
Features
• Finest haze production in its
class
• Small particle, even haze
• Continuous output
• 1 minute heat up time
• Water-based fluid with long
hang time
• Low noise
• Lightweight
• Optical Density Timer Control
system (ODTC)
• Variable haze and fan controls
with 5% increments
• 2.5 liter fluid capacity
• Max operating time at min
output (2.5 L) - 70 hours
• Sealed fluid system for
transportation
• Advanced Pump Technology
(APT)
• Shutdown with automatic startup cleaning mode (if shutdown
not performed correctly)
• Shutdown button prevents
clogging
• RDM ready
• On-board DMX 5pin
• User-friendly on-board control
panel
• Digital remote control option
• Optional flying kit and air
director
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Robust yet small and lightweight, the Jem Compact Hazer Pro
is a versatile haze machine designed for the highly demanding
professional market. Its ability to produce exceptional
atmospheric haze effects in a short period of time while
operating at low noise levels make it ideal for nearly any
application from shows and events to theatre, TV studios, clubs,
cruise ships, theme parks and more.
Physical
Length: 532 mm (20.9 in.)
Width: 224 mm (8.8 in.)
Height: 278 mm (10.9 in.)
Dry weight: 8.5 kg (18.7 lbs.)
Performance
Operating time: Continuous
Warm-up time: 60 sec
Maximum operating time at minimum output (2.5L): 70 Hours
Control and Programming
Control options: Onboard digital control panel with 4 digit display
Control options: Continuous or timer-controlled output, 0-100% adjustable output level
Control options: Adjustable fan speed level, 0-100%
DMX channels: 3 (Haze, Fan, Special functions)
RDM: RDM Ready
Optional digital remote control
Construction
Housing: Steel & aluminum
Heat exchanger: 900 W
Fluid System
Fluid pump: Oscillating piston, high pressure
Onboard fluid capacity: 2.5 l
Fluid consumption at peak output: 95 ml per hour
Compatible Fluids: Jem C-Plus Haze Fluid TM only
Installation
Orientation: Floor or optional flying kit
Connections
Power connection: Neutrik PowerCon
DMX data: 5-pin XLR
Remote control: 3-pin locking XLR
Electrical
AC power (EU models): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
AC power (US models): 110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
Main fuse (220-240 V power): 6.3 AT
Main fuse (110-120 V power): 10 AT
Thermal
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): 40° C (104° F)
Exterior surface temperature, steady state: 30° C (86° F)
Max. nozzle temperature: 290° C (554° F)
Approvals
EU safety (EU model)
ETL approvals (cETLus) pending
Accessories
Only for use with c-plus fluid
Jem Compact Hazer Pro Remote Control: P/N 92765040
Air Director: P/N 92625011
Flying Kit: P/N 92610003
Ordering Information
Jem Compact Hazer Pro, 110 V: P/N 92225960
Jem Compact Hazer Pro, 240 V: P/N 92225950
207
Jem AF-1™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Width: Height: Depth: Dry weight:
PERFORMANCE
Maximum airflow: Fan speed:
320 mm (12.6 in.)
350 mm (13.8 in.)
180 mm (7.1 in.)
10 kg (22.0 lbs.)
1600 m3 per hour
0-2500 rpm
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Steel
Connection
The Jem AF-1 is a compact but powerful fan designed with
clubs, studios, theatres and touring applications in mind. AF-1
features DMX input as standard and can be installed from the
ceiling, in the truss, or can be floor standing.
• Onboard DMX
• Multifunctional remote control
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin IEC
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Any
ELECTRICAL
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): Features
• Airflow: 1600 m3/hr
• Fan speed 0 - 2500 rpm
• Floor standing or truss mounting
Remote control: 0-10 V analog: DMX data:
Power connection:
220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
3.15 AT (slow blow)
5 AT (slow blow)
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Control options: Remote control (supplied), DMX, 0-10 V analog
Remote control features: Instant or timer-controlled output, 0-100% adjustable output level
Delay 2-144 seconds, run time 2-144 seconds
DMX channels: 1
Protocol: USITT DMX512/1990
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: US safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
UL Std. 507
included items
Analogue remote control c/w 5 m (16.4 ft.) cable:
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug: P/N 92765013
P/N 11501012
ORDERING INFORMATION
Jem AF-1 Fan, 110 V:
Jem AF-1 Fan, 240 V:
P/N 92615100
P/N 92615000
209
Jem AF-2™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Width: Height: Depth: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Maximum airflow: Fan speed: 682 mm (26.9 in.)
707 mm (27.8 in.)
318 mm (12.5 in.)
17 kg (37.5 lbs.)
6500 m3 per hour
0-1380 rpm
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Steel & aluminum
INSTALLATION
Orientation: The Jem AF-2 is a high-output, fully DMX controllable fan. It
has been designed with theme parks, stage applications and
theatres in mind.
Remote control: DMX data:
Power connection:
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin and 5-pin XLR sockets
3-pin IEC
ELECTRICAL
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): Features
Any
Connection
220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
5 AT (slow blow)
6.3 AT (slow blow)
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Control options: Remote control (supplied), onboard DMX
Remote control features: Instant or timer-controlled output, 0-100% adjustable output level
Delay 2-144 seconds, run time 2-144 seconds
DMX channels: 1
Protocol:
USITT DMX512/1990
APPROVALS
m3/hr
• Airflow: 6500
• Fan speed 0 - 1380 rpm
• Floor standing or truss mounting
• Optional “Touring Frame”
• Onboard DMX, 3 & 5 pin
• Multifunctional remote control
EU safety: EU safety: US safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
UL Std. 507
included items
Analogue remote control c/w 5 m (16.4 ft.) cable:
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug: P/N 92765013
P/N 11501012
ACCESSORIES
AF-2 Touring Frame:
P/N 92620006
ORDERING INFORMATION
Jem AF-2 Fan, 110 V:
Jem AF-2 Fan, 240 V:
P/N 92615400
P/N 92615300
211
Magnum 2500 Hz™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry Weight: 455 mm (17.9 in.)
285 mm (11.2 in.)
280 mm (11.0 in.)
11.9 kg (26.2 lbs.)
PERFORMANCE
2500 m3 per minute
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
6-8 minutes
Coverage volume: Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
DMX (optional accessory), Timer Remote
Instant or timer-controlled variable output
1
USITT DMX512/1990
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
900 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
The Magnum 2500 Hz is a plug-and-play, easy-to-use hazer
suitable for DJ’s, smaller venues, bars, and clubs. With a
large fluid container and optional DMX, the hazer is ideal for
installations.
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: INSTALLATION
Orientation: Floor
Connection
Power connections: DMX (with optional DMX interface):
Remote control:
Features
• Continuous output
• Output and density level control
• 2500 m³/min fog output
• Integrated fan
• 900 W heat exchanger
• 3.8 liter fluid capacity
Oscillating piston, high pressure
3.8 l
10.5 ml per minute
3-pin IEC male socket
3-pin and 5-pin XLR sockets
RJ-45
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Control options: Control options: DMX channels: Protocol: ELECTRICAL
• Fluid-out sensing
• Optional DMX interface
• Timer and output level remote control
• Internal remote control storage
• Linkable, up to 20 units can be
operated at the same time with
one remote or DMX
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
6.3 A
10 A
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
40° C (104° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: ETL approvals (cETLus): Immunity: EN 60 335-1 (1995)
EN 61000-6-3, EN 61000-3-2, EN 61000-3-3, EN 50366
UL Std. 998, CAN/CSA Std. C22.2 No 104-01
EN 61000-6-1, EN 61000-4-2, EN 61000-4-3
included items
3 m (9.8 ft.) power cable, IEC, w/o plug:
2 m (6.6 ft.) power cable with 3-pin IEC female connector (US model) Container 3.8 l: P/N 34300537
ACCESSORIES
Pro Haze (Haze mix) fluid
DMX Interface:
Remote control:
P/N 91612011
P/N 92765033
ORDERING INFORMATION
Martin Magnum 2500HZ, 110 V:
Martin Magnum 2500HZ, 240 V:
P/N 92225400
P/N 92225450
213
Magnum 2000™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: 695 mm (27.4 in.)
356 mm (14.0 in.)
325 mm (12.8 in.)
13 kg (28.7 lbs.)
PERFORMANCE
700 m3 per minute
180 minutes
8 minutes
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Warm-up time (approx.): CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
1500 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: The industry’s most specified fog machine ever, the Magnum
2000 is the authority in portable fog machines. Few other
portable foggers can match the output of the Magnum 2000, or
its logical plug and fog simplicity.
Oscillating piston, high pressure
9.5 l
95 ml per minute
INSTALLATION
Orientation:
Floor or flying kit
Connection
Remote control: 0-10 V analog:
Power cable entry:
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin locking XLR
Hard-wired
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Control options: Remote control (supplied), DMX with optional DMX interface module
Remote control features: Instant or timer-controlled variable output
ELECTRICAL
Features
• Continuous output
• 700 m3/min fog output
• 1600 W heat exchanger
• 8 min heat-up time
• Floor standing or truss mounting
• 9.5 liter fluid capacity
• Different fluid options for different applications
• DMX with optional DMX
interface module
• Optional DMX
• Onboard control panel
• Removable panel for remote control
• Timer and output level remote control
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
10 AT (slow blow)
15 AT (slow blow)
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
included items
Analogue remote control (panel mounted):
Hard wired mains cable 2 m (6.6 ft.): XLR Cable 5 m (16.4 ft.) (for remote): Container 9.5 l:
P/N 90760200
P/N 11820008
P/N 34300528
ACCESSORIES
Regular DJ (DJ mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Studio (DX Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Super (Fragranced) fluid
Pro Smoke High Density (SP Mix) fluid
I-fog fluid
Ducting Kit incl. adapter and 5 m of 4-inch (104mm) ducting:
DMX interface Magnum 2000:
P/N 92625006
P/N 90758020
ORDERING INFORMATION
Martin Magnum 2000, 230 V:
Martin Magnum 2000, 115 V:
P/N 92228000
P/N 92228100
215
Magnum 1800™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): 500 mm (19.7 in.)
232 mm (9.1 in.)
266 mm (10.5 in.)
15 kg (33.1 lbs.)
580 m3 per minute
90 minutes
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
9 minutes
Control options: Remote control features: Remote control (supplied), onboard DMX
Instant or timer-controlled variable output
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
1150 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
The Magnum 1800 is a high-powered fogger suitable for any
installation - from the largest to the smallest. Highly flexible, the
Magnum 1800 is built sleek and rugged.
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: Oscillating piston, high pressure
3.8 l
70 ml per minute
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Floor or flown in optional hanging bracket
Connection
DMX:
Remote control: Power cable entry:
ELECTRICAL
Features
• Continuous output
• 580 m3/min fog output
• 1150 W (240 V) /
1000 W (110 V) heat exchanger
• 9 min heat-up time
• Optional flying kit
• 3.8 liter fluid capacity
3-pin locking XLR
RJ-45
3-pin IEC
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
• Different fluid options for different applications
• Onboard DMX
• Internal remote control storage
• Timer and output level remote control
• Linkable, up to 20 units can be
operated at the same time with
one remote or DMX
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
6.3 AT (slow blow)
10 AT (slow blow)
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
included items
Remote control with 5 m (16.4 ft.) cable and RJ-45 connector:
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug: Container 3.8 l: P/N 92765032
P/N 11501012
P/N 34300537
ACCESSORIES
Regular DJ fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Studio (DX Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke High Density (SP Mix) fluid
I-Fog
Hanging bracket:
Ducting Kit:
P/N 92610011
P/N 92625009
ORDERING INFORMATION
Martin Magnum 1800, 240 V:
Martin Magnum 1800, 110 V:
P/N 92229011
P/N 92229000
217
Magnum 1200™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.):
450 mm (17.7 in.)
205 mm (8.1 in.)
244 mm (9.6 in.)
10 kg (22.0 lbs.)
290 m3 per minute
90 minutes
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
8 minutes
Control options: Remote control (supplied), DMX with optional DMX interface module
Remote control features: Instant or timer-controlled variable output
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
850 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
The Magnum 1200 delivers a heavy punch of fog. It’s built tough
to meet the rugged demands of 24/7 nightlife.
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: Oscillating piston, high pressure
2.3 l
50 ml per minute
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Floor or flying kit
Connection
Remote control: DMX (with optional DMX interface):
Power cable entry:
ELECTRICAL
Features
• Continuous output
• 290 m3/min fog output
• 850 W heat exchanger
• 8 min heat-up time
• Optional flying kit
• 2.3 liter fluid capacity
• Different fluid options for different applications
RJ-45
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin IEC
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
• Optional DMX interface
• Internal remote control storage
• Timer and output level remote control
• Linkable, up to 20 units can be
operated at the same time with
one remote or DMX
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
5 AT (slow blow)
10 AT (slow blow)
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: US safety (US model): EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
UL Std. 60335-1
included items
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug: Remote control with 5 m (16.4 ft.) cable and RJ-45 connector:
Container 2.3 l: P/N 11501012
P/N 92765032
P/N 34300536
ACCESSORIES
Regular DJ(DJ mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
DMX Interface:
Hanging bracket:
Ducting Kit:
P/N 91612011
P/N 92610010
P/N 92625009
ORDERING INFORMATION
Martin Magnum 1200, 110 V:
Martin Magnum 1200, 240 V:
P/N 92228910
P/N 92228911
219
Magnum 850™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): 409 mm (16.1 in.)
165 mm (6.5 in.)
186 mm (7.3 in.)
9.9 kg (21.8 lbs.)
200 m3 per minute
80 minutes
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
8 minutes
Control options: Remote control features: Remote control (supplied)
Manual switch
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
750 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
The Magnum 850 is the perfect fog machine for small
nightclubs, mobile DJs and bands. Compact and lightweight, it
offers substantial cost and maintenance benefits over a long
operational life.
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: Oscillating piston, high pressure
1l
35 ml per minute
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Floor
Connection
Remote control: Power connection:
RJ-45
3-pin IEC male socket
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
ELECTRICAL
Features
• Continuous output
• 200 m³/min fog output
• 750 W heat exchanger
• 8 minute heat-up time
• 1 liter fluid capacity
• Different fluid options for different applications
• Housing: Steel and aluminum
• Hand-held remote control
• Timer remote control (optional)
• Linkable, up to 20 units can be
operated at the same time with
one remote
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
6.3 AT (slow blow)
10 AT (slow blow)
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
40° C (104° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: US safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
UL Std. 60335-1
included items
Remote control:
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug: Container 1 l: P/N 92765030
P/N 11501012
P/N 34300001
ACCESSORIES
Regular DJ fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Timer Remote (Mag 850):
P/N 92765032
ORDERING INFORMATION
Martin Magnum 850, 110 V:
Martin Magnum 850, 240 V:
P/N 92229110
P/N 92229111
221
Magnum 650™
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Width: Height: Dry weight: PERFORMANCE
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Warm-up time (approx.): 293 mm (11.5 in.)
216 mm (8.5 in.)
170 mm (6.7 in.)
4.2 kg (9.3 lbs.)
160 m3 per minute
47 minutes
7 minutes
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Remote control (supplied)
Manual switch
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
600 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: The Magnum 650 offers the perfect boost of dense white fog to
enhance every light effect. The fast heat-up time and extended
operational period place the Magnum 650 as the clear leader
in its class.
Oscillating piston, high pressure
1l
23 ml per minute
INSTALLATION
Orientation: Floor
Connection
Remote control: Power connection:
Hard-wired
3-pin IEC male socket
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Control options: Remote control features: ELECTRICAL
Features
• 160 m3/min fog output
• 600 W heat exchanger
• 7 min heat-up time
• 1 liter fluid capacity
• Different fluid options for different applications
• Housing: Steel and aluminum
• Hand-held remote control
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power): Main fuse (110-120 V power): 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
5 AT (slow blow)
10 AT (slow blow)
THERMAL
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: US safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
UL Std. 60335-1
included items
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug:
Container 1 l: P/N 11501012
P/N 34300001
ACCESSORIES
Regular DJ fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
ORDERING INFORMATION
Martin Magnum 650, 110 V:
Martin Magnum 650, 240 V:
P/N 92228810
P/N 92228811
223
Magnum Club Smoke™
CONTROL AND PROGRAMMING
Control options: Remote control features: Timer range: DMX channels: Protocol: Remote control (supplied), DMX, 0-10 V analog
Instant or timer-controlled variable output
Delay time 2-144 seconds, run time 2-144 seconds
1
USITT DMX512/1990
CONSTRUCTION
Housing: Heat exchanger: Steel & aluminum
1000 W, direct thermal protection
FLUID SYSTEM
Oscillating piston, high pressure X2
10 l
100 ml per minute, per head
INSTALLATION
Orientation (Head): Orientation (Base): Any (ceiling panel or wall recommended)
Floor or wall mount
connections
Remote control: DMX data:
Power cable entry:
Magnum Club Smoke is a unique twin-headed fog package
with a remote, groundbased fluid supply. The two compact fog
heads (each with a 1000 W heater) deliver a continuous, high
volume of dense white fog.
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin locking XLR
3-pin IEC male socket
ELECTRICAL
AC power (EU models): AC power (US models): Main fuse (220-240 V power) Head: Main fuse (110-120 V power) Head: Main fuse (220-240 V power) Base: Main fuse (110-120 V power) Base: 220-240 V nominal, 50 Hz
110-120 V nominal, 60 Hz
6.3 AT (slow blow)
12.5 AT (slow blow)
3.15 AT (slow blow)
5 AT (slow blow)
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Fluid pump: Onboard fluid capacity: Fluid consumption at peak output: THERMAL
Features
• Base unit allows heads to be positioned up to 50 meters away
• Up to 4 heads in one system
• Continuous output
• 500 m3/min fog output (per head)
• 1000 W heat exchanger
• 7 min heat-up time
• Truss mounting
• 10 liter fluid capacity
• Different fluid options for different applications
• Onboard DMX
• Multifunctional remote control
Maximum ambient temperature (Ta max.): Exterior surface temperature, steady state: Max. nozzle temperature: 40° C (104° F)
50° C (122° F)
200° C (392° F)
APPROVALS
EU safety: EU safety: EN 50 081-1, EN 50 082-1
EN 60 335-1 (1995)
included items
Power cable 1.5 m (4.9 ft.) IEC w/o end plug:
P/N 11501012
Analogue remote control c/w 5 m (16.4 ft.) cable:
P/N 92765014
Container 10 l:
P/N 34300520
Fluid line 6 mm (0.2 in.) x 10 m (32.8 ft.) (head):
P/N 62520020
Fluid line ’tee’ piece 6 mm (0.2 in.) x 6 mm (0.2 in.) x 6 mm (0.2 in.)(c/w head):P/N 26460060
ACCESSORIES
Regular DJ fluid
Pro Smoke Super (ZR Mix) fluid
Pro Smoke Super (Fragranced) fluid
I-fog fluid
10 m length of 6 mm fluid line for Club Smoke head*:
P/N 62520020
T-connector for Club Smoke fluid line:
P/N 26460060
*For alternative lengths please contact [email protected]
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length (Head): Width (Head): Height (Head): Dry Weight (Head): Length (Base): Width (Base): Height (Base): Dry weight (Base): PERFORMANCE
Max. fog output (approx.): Max. operating time at full output (approx.): Operating time: Warm-up time (approx.): 330 mm (13.0 in.)
310 mm (12.2 in.)
165 mm (6.5 in.)
10 kg (22.0 lbs.)
410 mm (16.1 in.)
290 mm (11.4 in.)
480 mm (18.9 in.)
12 kg (26.5 lbs.)
ORDERING INFORMATION
Martin Magnum Club Smoke Base, 110 V:
Martin Magnum Club Smoke Base, 240 V:
Martin Magnum Club Smoke Heads (x2), 110 V:
Martin Magnum Club Smoke Heads (x2), 240 V:
P/N 92250100
P/N 92250000
P/N 92620001
P/N 92620000
500 m3 per minute per head
71 minutes (full 4-head system)
Continuous, automatic level adjustment
7 minutes
225
Jem Glaciator X-Stream™
Jem Hydra™
Jem K1 Hazer™
Commercial / Architectural
Events /Corporate
Rental / Hire
Simulation / Training
Theme parks / Resorts etc
Cruise ships
Stadium / Arena
Theatre / Show
TV Studio / Film
Night club & Bar Medium - large venues
Night club & Bar Small venues
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Application
Mobile DJ
Smoke and Haze Machine Application Chart*
Jem Compact Hazer Pro™
Jem Roadie Compact™
Jem Roadie X-Stream™
Jem ZR44 Hi-Mass™
Magnum 1200™
Magnum 1800™
Magnum 2000™
Magnum 2500 Hz™
Magnum 850™
Magnum 650™
Magnum Club Smoke™
* Above chart are guidelines only
Primary Application
Secondary Application
227
Jem Roadie X-Stream™
Jem Roadie Compact™
Regular DJ Fluid (DJ mix)™
Pro Steam Simulation™
Pro Smoke Super (ZR mix)™
Pro Smoke Studio (DX mix)™
Pro Smoke High Density™
Pro Haze Fluid™
C+Fluid™
K1 Haze Fluid™
i-fog™
Heavy Fog Fluid (C3 mix)™
Jem Glaciator X-Stream™
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
Heavy Fog Fluid (B2 mix)™
Fluid Matrix
Jem Hydra™
Jem zr44 Hi-Mass™
Jem K1 Hazer™
Jem Compact Hazer Pro™
Magnum 2500 hz™
Magnum 2000™
Magnum 1800™
Magnum 1200™
Magnum 850™
Magnum 650™
Magnum Club Smoke™
Recommended
May also be used (with possible recalibration needed)
229
Fog and Haze Fluids
K1 Haze fluid™
K1 Haze Fluid is specially developed for the Jem K1 Hazer. The fluid is optimized to create
small particulate haze with a high degree of uniformity, perfect for beam projection.
Besides delivering a unique effect, the K1 Haze Fluid is formulated to generate a long
operating and hang time. Hence the Jem K1 Hazer has a very low fluid consumption
when running on this dedicated fluid.
Pro Smoke Super (ZR mix)™
This industry standard fluid is the automatic choice of most users. A dense white
airborne fog is produced with a medium length dispersal time. Its medium to high index
of refraction makes this formula ideal for all effects. Available in 4 x 5 l, 9.5 l, 25 l and
220 l containers.
Pro Smoke Studio (DX mix)™
In a studio or theatre environment, a lighter, faster dispersing fog is often preferred. ProSmoke Studio offers a less dense environment to Pro-Smoke Super and is therefore less
likely to interfere with TV camera focusing. Available in 4 x 5 l containers.
Martin offers the widest and most popular range of atmosphere
generating fog, haze and heavy fog fluid around. Ideal for use
in theatres, discos, clubs, concerts, festivals and even television
applications, our fluid is effective, safe and economical. All fluids
are environmentally friendly and water based. They are made
from the highest quality food grade polyfunctional alcohols
which are diluted with water and purified by double reverse
osmosis and an ultra-violet filtration process. This guarantees a
virtually mineral and bacteria free product.
We want you to be totally satisfied with your fog machine. Only
by using our fluid can you be 100% guaranteed that your fog
machine will operate optimally. Possible problems, including
a shortened machine life and possible health risks, may occur
with use of other types of fog fluid.
Pro Smoke High Density (SP mix)™
The SP mix generates a high density, white, airborne fog with a very high index of
refraction and slower evaporation rate. It is well suited for scenic obscuring and strobes
“white-out”. Available in 4 x 5 l, 9.5 l and 220 l containers.
HAZE
Pro Haze fluid™
Specially formulated for the range of hazers including ZR 24/7, Magnum Hazer and
Magnum 2500 Hz this fluid is also ideal for use with the Roadie X-Stream and Roadie
Compact when in Haze mode. A fine optically transparent airborne medium is produced
with a light to medium index of refraction - ideal for beam projection. Available in 4 x 2.5
l, 9.5 l and 220 l containers.
Heavy fog fluid (C3 mix)™
A longer lasting, higher density fog is sometimes required in a more controlled
environment. With its longer “hang time”, C3 Mix is ideal for “waterfall” and “curtain”
type effects. Available in 4 x 5 l and 220 l containers.
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
FOG
i-fog™
i-fog is not only kind to your lights, but is also more economical to use thanks to its
incredible long “hang time” characteristics. In environments unaffected by extraction
and air-conditioning, i-fog can be expected to last 30% longer. In fact it is essential that
all auto-timer programmed foggers be adjusted to lower output, shorter duration and
longer delays in repeat firing, to avoid atmospheric saturation. Available in 4 x 5 l, 9.5 l
and 220 l containers.
Regular DJ fluid (DJ mix)™
This specially formulated economy mix is perfect for medium density, airborne fog
effects. It is particularly well suited for the Magnum 650 and 850. Available in 4 x 5 l, 9.5
l and 220 l containers.
Pro Steam Simulation™
Steam simulation fluid specifically designed for ‘steam’ effects. Creates a white burst, but
is fast dispersing. Used in the Hydra system, ZR44 Hi-Mass or the Roadie Compact you
get ‘CO2 burst’ line effects. Available in 9.5 l and 25 l containers
HEAVY FOG
Heavy fog fluid (B2 mix)™
This specially made fluid produces a dense ground-hugging effect which will disperse
and evaporate before any visible rising. B2 is ideally suited for dramatic scenes involving
a lot of stage activity or dance. Available in 4 x 5 l, 25 l and 220 l containers.
C-Plus fluid™
This extremely light, molecular fluid produces very fine haze particles and was designed
for the Jem Compact Hazer Pro™ only. Specially made to highlight light beams and lasers,
C-Plus fluid produces an evenly dispersed atmospheric haze with an exceptionally long
hang time for optimal visual clarity.
231
Accessories
DUCTING SYSTEMS
The range of Ducting Systems is designed for use when the fog needs to be distributed
to less accessible locations. The wide diameter ducting will minimize condensation and
maximize fog flow.
•Available for: Magnum 650, Magnum 850, Magnum 1200, Magnum 1800, Magnum 2000, ZR44 Hi-Mass, Glaciator X-Stream and Roadie Compact.
• Ducting Systems come with ducting adapter and 5 meters of ducting.
• Glaciator Twin Ducting System - includes twin outlet ducting adapter, fixings and 2 x 5 m of 150 mm diameter ducting.
HYDRA ACCESSORIES
The list of accessories for the Hydra system is available for larger installations or longer
fluid line runs. Also the list features the Self-sealed Connectors that allow you to easily
service the system or even take it on touring!
• Self-seal Connector 2x6 mm
• Self-seal Connector 2x10 mm
• Connector 2x10 mm straight
• Tubing 10 mm, 30 m
• Tubing 6 mm, 50 m
ATMOSPHERIC EFFECTS
DRIP TRAYS
All installers of night club fogging systems will appreciate this useful accessory. The slim
line tray simply attaches to the front edge of the fog machine and is designed to catch
any small drops of condensation, which typically form around the fog output nozzle. The
tray is fitted with a highly absorbent material, which will dry out automatically thanks to
the heat transfer from the machines’ vaporizing chamber.
JEM COMPACT HAZER PRO AIR DIRECTOR
The Air Director redirects haze output for more accurate placement.
MAGNUM CLUB SMOKE ACCESSORIES
The Magnum Club Smoke is supplied with the accessories needed to get you started.
However, it may be necessary to extend fluid lines or add extra Fog Heads. A full range
of fluid line connectors is available to meet the varying challenges of club installations.
All fittings are of a “push-in” type and require no tools.
• 6 mm Nylon Fluid Line
• 6 mm to 6mm Push-in Connectors (for joining lengths of 6mm fluid line)
• 6 mm “T” Connector (for splitting fluid supply to an additional (Fog Head)
A comprehensive range of accessories is available to enhance
the capabilities of our fog and haze generators. Every installation,
theatrical production or staged event has specific requirements
and Martin smoke machine accessories help to tailor our
standard range of machines for these special applications.
Our fog and haze machines are designed to give long reliable
service. However, it is quite conceivable that your requirements
might change and when they do, many of yesterday’s models
can be simply upgraded for today’s needs.
DMX INTERFACE
Martin’s range of DMX interfaces for Magnum and Jem smoke machines allows you
to upgrade most models of Fog and Haze Machines from Analog control (standard fog
machine controller) to accepting a control signal from a DMX Source.
• DMX Interface for Magnum 2000
• DMX Interface for Magnum 1200
• DMX Interface for Magnum 2500 Hz
REMOTE CONTROL
Many Martin fog and haze machines are supplied with a remote control, or with the
possibility to use a remote control. Martin offers several remote controls such as simple
on/off remotes, timer and output control remotes, and digital remote controls to run fog
and haze machines from backstage.
JEM COMPACT HAZER PRO HANGING BRACKET
233
ACCESSORIES
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Gobos
Colors
Lenses and filters
Lamps
Rigging
Flightcases
Cables
Tools
Service
235
Colors
Gobos are thin masks used to create special lighting
patterns, textures or effects and can also be used to
project images and logos. As visually important as color, gobo
patterns can add dramatic or subtle effects to any projection
surface.
The Martin gobo selection includes all the most popular and
useful designs and are always available for instant delivery.
View the complete selection of Martin gobos at www.martin
com
Martin lights are equipped with high-quality dichroic color
filters enabling rich and long-lasting color projections.
The advantage of using dichroic filters is the durability and
efficiency they offer. Dichroic filters are designed to
reflect – rather than absorb – light’s energy and since they
absorb little heat, they can transmit more light and remain
stable without fading or burning out. They also provide excellent color uniformity with no edge distortion, stray colors or
halation effects.
A wide variety of different color options is available. To view
the full array of available colors, visit the Martin website at
www.martin.com. For special color requests, contact your
local Martin dealer.
ACCESSORIES
Gobos
237
Lamps
Lenses and filters
Accessories for MAC 101
Set of 8 narrow-angle diffusers for MAC 101
Set of 8 medium-angle diffusers for MAC 101
Accessories for Stagebar 2
Set of 4 Narrow diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 S
Set of 4 Medium diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 S
Set of 4 Narrow diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 L
Set of 4 Medium diffuser filters, Stagebar 2 L
Accessories for MAC 2000 Wash XB
MAC 2000 Wash + XB Beam Kit
Front module with Fresnel lens (installed)
Front module with PC lens
Front module with super wide-angle lens
P/N 91616023
P/N 91616018
P/N 91614035
P/N 91614036
P/N 91614037
P/N 91614038
P/N 91610103
P/N 55203003
P/N 55203006
P/N 55203012
Type
Wattage
Used in
97010307
Xenon
3000
Atomic 3000 DMX
MAX-15 Xenon lamp
97010308
MAX-7 Xenon lamp
Xenon
3000
Atomic 3000 DMX
97010322
Osram HTI 1500 W/D7/60
SharXS lamp
Metal Halide
1500
MAC 2000 Wash XB
97010347
Osram HTI 1500W/60/
P50 lamp
Metal Halide
1500
MAC III Performance
MAC III Profile
97010332
GE CSR1500/S/DE/60S
Staybright lamp
Metal Halide
1500
MAC 2000 Beam XB *
MAC 2000 Wash XB *
97010340
Philips MSR Gold 1500
Fastfit 1CT
Metal Halide
1500
MAC III Performance *
MAC III Profile *
97010345
Philips MSR Gold 1510
SA/DE lamp
Metal Halide
1500
MAC 2000 Beam XB *
MAC 2000 Wash XB *
97010348
HTI 1500W/60/P50 M3W
Metal Halide
1500
MAC III AirFX
MAC III Wash
97000006
Philips Hi-Brite 1200/80
FastFit 80 V lamp
Tungsten Halogen
1200
MAC TW1, 80 V *
97000112
Philips 1200/115
FastFit 115 V lamp
Tungsten Halogen
1200
MAC TW1 *
97000113
Philips 1200/230
FastFit 230 V lamp
Tungsten Halogen
1200
MAC TW1 *
97000114
Philips 1200/240
FastFit 240 V lamp
Tungsten Halogen
1200
MAC TW1 *
97010304
Osram HTI 1200
D7/60 SharXS lamp
Metal Halide
1200
MAC 2000 Performance ll *
MAC 2000 Profile ll *
MAC 2000 Wash *
97010310
Philips MSR 1200
SA/DE Gold lamp
Metal Halide
1200
MAC 2000 Performance ll
MAC 2000 Profile ll
MAC 2000 Wash
97010313
Philips MSD 1200 lamp
Metal Halide
1200
Exterior 1200 Image Projector
Exterior 1200 Wash
97010330
GE CSR1200/S/DE/60
lamp
Metal Halide
1200
MAC 2000 Performance II *
MAC
2000 Profile II *
MAC 2000 Wash *
97010331
GE CSR1200/S/DE/60S
Staybright lamp
Metal Halide
1200
MAC 2000 Performance II *
MAC 2000 Profile II *
MAC 2000 Wash *
97010346
LOK-IT HTI 1000W/PS
Metal Halide
1000
MAC Viper Profile
MAC Viper AirFX
MAC Viper Wash
97010212
Osram HTI 700/
D4/75 lamp
Metal Halide
700
MAC 700 Profile
MAC 700 Wash
97010240
GE CSR700/S/DE/60 lamp Metal Halide
Philips MSR Gold 700
SA/2 DE
Sylvania BA 700/2 DE S 7,5
700
MAC 700 Profile *
MAC 700 Wash *
97010312
Philips MSR Gold 700
SA/2 DE lamp
Metal Halide
700
MAC 700 Profile *
MAC 700 Wash *
97010200
Osram HSR 575/2 lamp
Metal Halide
575
Exterior 600 *
MAC 600 *
MAC 600 NT *
97010201
Philips MSR 575/2 lamp
Metal Halide
575
Exterior 600 *
MAC 600
MAC 600 NT
ACCESSORIES
Martin offers a variety of narrow to wide angle lenses,
diffusers and filters useful in manipulating the light beam.
Made of the highest quality materials, they are available
as accessories on select Martin products.
Part Number Lamp
* Approved for this product., but not included
239
Lamps
Lamps
Part Number Lamp
Type
Wattage
Used in
Part Number Lamp
Type
Wattage
Used in
97010202
Philips MSD 575 lamp
Metal Halide
575
Exterior 600
MAC 600 *
MAC 600 NT *
97010113
Metal Halide
150
FiberSource B150
FiberSource CMY150
97010207
Osram HSD 575 lamp
Metal Halide
575
Exterior 600 *
MAC 600 *
MAC 600 NT *
Philips CDM-SA/R
150 lamp
Philips MSD 150/2 lamp
Metal Halide
150
smartMAC
Philips EFP/8H 12 V,
100 W lamp
Halogen
100
Mania DC1
Mania DC2
Mania EF2
Mania EF3
Mania EF4
97020006
Osram T5 FQ 54 W/60
HO red tube
Fluorescent
54
Cyclo Directional
Cyclo IP65 Directional
Stage Cyclo
Cyclo IP65 03
Cyclo IP65 03 DMX
97010230
GE CSR 575/S/DE/70 lamp Metal Halide
575
MAC 575 Krypton
97010211
Osram HTI 400/D3 lamp
Metal Halide
400
MAC 550
97000104
Osram ELC, 24 V / 250 W,
50 hour halogen lamp
Halogen
250
Raptor *
T-Rex *
97000107
Philips 500 h ELC
halogen lamp
Halogen
250
T-Rex *
97000108
Osram ELC-7/X,
24 V / 250 W,
700 hour halogen lamp
Halogen
250
T-Rex *
97020007
Osram T5 FQ 54 W/66
HO green tube
Fluorescent
54
97000111
Philips ELC 10H
250 W 1000 hour lamp
Halogen
250
Mania EFX500
Mania SCX600
Raptor
T-Rex
Cyclo Directional
Cyclo IP65 Directional
Stage Cyclo
Cyclo IP65 03
Cyclo IP65 03 DMX
97020008
Osram T5 FQ 54 W/67
HO blue tube
Fluorescent
54
Cyclo Directional
Cyclo IP65 Directional
Stage Cyclo
Cyclo IP65 03
Cyclo IP65 03 DMX
97020009
Osram T5 FQ 54 W/827 HO
2700 K warm white tube
Fluorescent
54
Stage Cyclo *
Cyclo IP65 Directional *
97020010
Osram T5 FQ 54 W/840 HO
4000 K cool white tube
Fluorescent
54
Stage Cyclo *
Cyclo IP65 Directional *
MAC 250 Entour *
MAC 250 Wash *
Wizard Extreme
MAC 250 Krypton *
97020011
Osram T5 FQ 54 W/865 HO
6500 K daylight white tube
Fluorescent
54
Stage Cyclo *
Cyclo IP65 Directional *
97000005
Osram ENL 12 V, 50 W lamp
Halogen
50
Alien 05 Recessed
Alien 05 Stem Mount
97020000
Osram T5 FH 28 W/827 HE
2700 K warm white tube
Fluorescent
28
Cyclo 02
Cyclo 04 *
Cyclo 04 Wallwasher *
Cyclo IP65 02
Cyclo IP65 02 DMX
Cyclo IP65 04 *
Cyclo IP65 04 DMX *
97020001
Osram T5 FH 28 W/840 HE
4000 K cool white tube
Fluorescent
28
Cyclo 04
Cyclo 04 DMX
Cyclo 04 Wallwasher
Cyclo IP65 04
Cyclo IP65 04 DMX
97020002
Osram T5 FH 28 W/860
6000 K white
Fluorescent
28
Cyclo 02
Cyclo 04 *
Cyclo 04 Wallwasher
Cyclo IP65 02
Cyclo IP65 02 DMX
Cyclo IP65 04 *
Cyclo IP65 04 DMX *
97000115
Philips 6958 10H 24 V,
250 W 1000 hour lamp
Halogen
250
Mania DC3
Mania PR1
97010100
Philips MSD 250/2 lamp
Metal Halide
250
MAC 250 Krypton *
Wizard Extreme *
CX-10 Extreme
MAC 250 Entour *
MAC 250 Wash *
MX-10 Extreme
97010116
Osram HSD 250/80 lamp
Metal Halide
250
97010119
Sylvania BA 250/2
Metal Halide
250
MAC 250 Entour
MAC 250 Wash
Wizard Extreme
MAC 250 Krypton
97000110
Philips EFR/5H JCR 15 V,
150 W H5 halogen lamp
Halogen
150
Mania SCX500
97010101
Osram HQI-R 150 lamp
Metal Halide
150
FiberSource CMY150 *
FiberSource QFX 150
97010111
Philips CDM-SA/T
150 W lamp
Metal Halide
150
Alien 02 Pendant
Alien 02 Spot
Exterior 200
Inground 200
Mania SCX700
Mania SCX800
smartMAC*
Mania EFX600
Mania EFX700
Mania EFX800
* Approved for this product., but not included
ACCESSORIES
97010117
97000004
* Approved for this product., but not included
241
Lamps
Rigging
Part Number Lamp
Type
Wattage
Used in
97020003
Fluorescent
28
Cyclo 03
Cyclo 03 DMX
Cyclo 04
Cyclo 04 DMX
Cyclo 04 Wallwasher
Cyclo IP65 04
Cyclo IP65 04 DMX
Cyclo IP65 03
Cyclo IP65 03 DMX
97020004
Osram T5 FH 28 W/66
HE green tube
Osram T5 FH 28 W/67
HE blue tube
Fluorescent
Fluorescent
28
28
Cyclo 03
Cyclo 03 DMX
Cyclo 04
Cyclo 04 DMX
Cyclo 04 Wallwasher
Cyclo IP65 04
Cyclo IP65 04 DMX
Cyclo IP65 03
Cyclo IP65 03 DMX
Cyclo 03
Cyclo 03 DMX
Cyclo 04
Cyclo 04 DMX
Cyclo 04 Wallwasher
Cyclo IP65 04
Cyclo IP65 04 DMX
Cyclo IP65 03
Cyclo IP65 03 DMX
CLAMPS
Martin clamps are manufactured from premium extruded aluminum, are supplied
with a grade 8.8 M12 bolt and self-locking nut, and fasten to existing or new ¼turn omega brackets. All clamps and brackets come with TÜV and SWL markings.
HALF-COUPLER CLAMPS
Martin half-coupler clamps fit 48 to 51 mm (1⅞- 2 inch) diameter trusses and
provide a large contact area for excellent grip. Martin half-couplers mount fixtures
close to the truss and cause minimal truss wear and tear. An M12 bolt for fastening
to omega brackets is included.
G-CLAMPS
Martin G-clamps fit 40 - 51 mm (1½ - 2 inch) diameter trusses and their ribbed
aluminum clamping surfaces give better grip than steel. The wide, spring-loaded
clamp plate tightens securely without scratching. Martin G-clamps are low-cost
and include an M12 bolt.
ACCESSORIES
97020005
Osram T5 FH 28 W/60
HE red tube
QUICK TRIGGER CLAMP
Compact and mounted in a couple of seconds, the Martin quick trigger clamp
can be used with 38.1 - 51 mm (1½ - 2 inch) diameter trusses. The clamp has
spring-loaded jaws, a large, easy-grip T-handle for rapid leveraged tightening and
an M12 bolt.
OMEGA BRACKET
The standard Martin omega bracket with ¼-turn fasteners gives a fast, secure
attachment point for rigging clamps on Martin fixtures.
T-SHAPED OMEGA BRACKET
The Martin T-shaped omega bracket is a flexible system for attaching fixtures to
trusses with different dimensions. Adjustable clamp spacing allows the ¼- turn
omega brackets to be used with all MAC fixtures (except the MAC 101) in all
common truss designs.
SUPER TRUSS BRACKET
The Super Truss bracket can be used to hang MAC products* on a truss with 20.5”
(52 cm) spacing between front and back bars. This allows fixtures to be hung
closer together while keeping them centered on the truss. The bracket comes
complete with half-couplers.
SWING WING MOUNTING PLATE
The Swing Wing bracket can be used to hang MAC products* in Tomcat Global’s
Swing Wing truss. It gives greater clearance between the fixture and the floor
during transit by hanging the fixture close to the mounting bar. It comes complete
with half-couplers.
* MAC III Series, MAC 2000 Series, MAC 700 Series, MAC 575 Krypton, MAC TW1
ORDERING INFORMATION
Half-coupler clamp
G-clamp:
Quick trigger clamp:
Standard omega clamp attachment bracket with ¼ -turn fasteners:
T-shaped omega clamp attachment bracket with ¼ turn fasteners:
Swing wing mounting plate with half-couplers:
Super Truss 20,5’’ mounting plate with half-couplers: P/N 91602005
P/N 91602003
P/N 91602007
P/N 91602001
P/N 91602008
P/N 91602010
P/N 91602014
243
Rigging
Safety wire
RAINMAC
Martin safety cables are designed for easy attachment. A 50
kg (110 lb.) SWL (Safe Working Load) version is available for all
Martin fixtures except the MAC III, for which a 70 kg (154 lb.)
SWL version is available.
The RainMAC is a simple and effective way to protect your
MAC luminaires from rain and moisture.  Ideal for festivals and
outdoor events, the tough, UV-resistant RainMAC covers the
base of any MAC moving light to protect it from the worst of the
elements, enabling your show to keep running in wet weather.
Extremely easy to fit, the RainMAC has 12 slots for all Omega
Bracket positions and has attachment points for safety wires.
Plastic plugs close the unused slots, deflecting a degree of
moisture or rain. The RainMAC stacks easily for transport and
is flexible and robust.
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Length: Wire diameter: SWL: 685 mm (27 in.)
6 mm (0.24 in.)
70 kg (154 lbs.)
ACCESSORIES
Rigging
ORDERING INFORMATION
Safety wire, SWL 70 kg:
P/N 91604004
PHYSICAL
Length: Wire diameter:
SWL:
600 mm (23.6 in.)
5 mm (0.2 in.)
50 kg (110 lbs.)
ORDERING INFORMATION
Safety wire, SWL 50 kg: P/N 91604003
Specifications
PHYSICAL
Width: Length: Weight: 465 mm (18.3 in.)
525 mm (20.7 in.)
1.1 kg (2.4 lbs.)
ORDERING INFORMATION
RainMAC (minimum order 4 items):                P/N 91611082
245
Cables
In order to fully protect and conveniently transport Martin lights
while on the move, a full range of durable flightcases is available.
Built to endure the rigors of the touring and rental market,
these classic cases are manufactured from top-quality, waterresistant 9 mm ply. The exterior is covered in a tough, waterrepellent, black grained finish with 30 mm aluminum edge
protection and tough steel corners.
Resilient roller castors are mounted to the base for easy rollon/roll-out and convenient spring-back, steel carrying handles
provide for easy grip and handling.
For product specific flightcases, see Accessories and/or Ordering
Information under each product.
For reliable, trouble-free communication, Martin offers a variety
of high-quality link cables (24 AWG) and rugged Ethernet cables
(26 AWG) of various lengths, as well as converters and DMX
termination plugs. Martin cables are designed to withstand the
extreme conditions of the professional touring segment from
frequent usage and coiling to constant weathering.
ACCESSORIES
Flightcases
247
Tools
The Fixture Beam Analyzer uses a standard webcam (not
included) to analyze a lighting fixture’s output on any surface,
making lamp adjustments an easier and more accurate
procedure for a more uniform field of light.
ACCESSORIES
Fixture Beam Analyzer™
Features
• E asier, more accurate lamp
adjustments
• Fixtures run more efficiently and
at maximum output
• N
o need to stare into the field of
light
• Easy to use - no experience or
training required
ORDERING INFORMATION
Fixture Beam Analyzer, Complete Fixture Beam Analyzer, Hardware P/N 91611350
P/N 91611351
249
Martin Service
Martin Professional is the only intelligent lighting manufacturer to offer a complete and comprehensive service package
anywhere in the world.
7 days a week, 24 hours a day, we are there for you.
Martin Service protects your investment and ensures your
equipment operates at its optimum performance year after
year, no matter what the environment.
24 hour support hotline:
• Worldwide: +45 87 40 00 00
• USA: 1-888-TECH-180
SERVICE
With a range of service contracts to suit each and every application, Martin Service takes the hassle out of installation
and maintenance and gives you a true and healthy return on
your investment.
Martin Service offers:
• Trouble-free installation
• Equipment upgrades
• Easy access to spare parts
• Optimized return on investment
• Access to product expertise
• Product training
• Extended warranty
• On-line advice
• On-site service contracts
251
Worldwide Partners
Martin Professional operates the industry’s most complete
and capable distributor network with local partners in nearly
100 countries. For a detailed list of our distributors, please
visit www.martin.com/distributor
INDEX
253
Index
LAMPS.......................................................................................................................................239
2510 CONTROLLER™............................................................................................................158
LC PLUS SERIES™..................................................................................................................102
ACCESSORIES.........................................................................................................................234
lenses & filters.................................................................................................................238
ATOMIC 3000 DMX™..............................................................................................................54
LIGHTJOCKEY 2™...................................................................................................................156
ATOMIC COLORS™..................................................................................................................56
M1™ ...........................................................................................................................................128
cables™...................................................................................................................................247
m2go™......................................................................................................................................131
CLAMPS....................................................................................................................................243
m2pc™.......................................................................................................................................134
COLORFOX™............................................................................................................................160
MAC 101 CLD™.........................................................................................................................20
COLORS.....................................................................................................................................237
MAC 101 CT™............................................................................................................................ 18
DETONATOR™............................................................................................................................58
MAC 101 WRM™......................................................................................................................22
MAC 101™................................................................................................................................... 16
MAC 301 WASH™.....................................................................................................................24
ETHER2DMX8™.......................................................................................................................180
MAC 350 ENTOUR™................................................................................................................28
EXTERIOR 100 IP68™..............................................................................................................66
MAC 700 PROFILE™.................................................................................................................30
EXTERIOR 1200 IMAGE PROJECTOR™.............................................................................88
MAC 700 WASH™.....................................................................................................................33
EXTERIOR 1200 WASH™........................................................................................................82
MAC AURA™.............................................................................................................................26
EXTERIOR 200™........................................................................................................................ 70
mac iii AirFX™........................................................................................................................46
EXTERIOR 400 IMAGE PROJECTOR™...............................................................................86
MAC III PERFORMANCE™....................................................................................................43
EXTERIOR 400™........................................................................................................................72
MAC III PROFILE™....................................................................................................................40
EXTERIOR 410™........................................................................................................................ 74
mac iii wash™........................................................................................................................49
EXTERIOR 420™........................................................................................................................ 76
MAC TW1™.................................................................................................................................35
EXTERIOR 430™........................................................................................................................ 79
mac viper profile™............................................................................................................ 37
EXTERIOR 50 IP68™.................................................................................................................64
MAGNUM 1200™...................................................................................................................218
EXTERIOR 600™........................................................................................................................80
MAGNUM 1800™...................................................................................................................216
FIBERSOURCE CMY150™.....................................................................................................92
MAGNUM 2000™...................................................................................................................214
FIBERSOURCE QFX150™.......................................................................................................90
MAGNUM 2500 HZ™............................................................................................................212
FLIGHTCASES..........................................................................................................................246
MAGNUM 650™.....................................................................................................................222
FLUID MATRIX........................................................................................................................228
MAGNUM 850™.....................................................................................................................220
FOG AND HAZE FLUIDS......................................................................................................226
MAGNUM CLUB SMOKE™................................................................................................224
GOBOS.......................................................................................................................................236
MARTIN DMX 5.3 SPLITTER™............................................................................................184
INGROUND 200™....................................................................................................................84
MARTIN RDM 5.5 SPLITTER™............................................................................................186
IOS MAXREMOTE™...............................................................................................................140
MARTIN SHOWDESIGNER™.............................................................................................. 176
JEM AF-1™ ..............................................................................................................................208
MARTIN USB DUO DMX INTERFACE™.........................................................................182
JEM AF-2™................................................................................................................................210
MAXEDIA BROADCAST™....................................................................................................166
JEM compact hazer pro™...........................................................................................206
MAXEDIA CAPTURE CARD™.............................................................................................175
JEM GLACIATOR X-STREAM™..........................................................................................194
MAXEDIA COMPACT™.........................................................................................................172
JEM HYDRA™..........................................................................................................................200
MAXEDIA PRO™.....................................................................................................................169
JEM K1 HAZER™....................................................................................................................204
MAXMODULE BUTTON™ ..................................................................................................153
JEM ROADIE COMPACT™...................................................................................................198
MAXMODULE CEREBRUM™ . .........................................................................................144
JEM ROADIE X-STREAM™..................................................................................................196
MAXMODULE FRAME™ ....................................................................................................155
JEM ZR44 HI-MASS™...........................................................................................................202
MAXMODULE PLAYBACK™ .............................................................................................149
INDEX
EC-10™.........................................................................................................................................98
EC-20™.......................................................................................................................................100
255
MAXMODULE PROGRAMMER™ ................................................................................... 147
MAXMODULE SUBMASTER™ .........................................................................................151
MAXXYZ COMPACT™ .........................................................................................................141
M-PC™ ......................................................................................................................................137
MUM™ / DABS 1™.................................................................................................................162
P3-100 SYSTEM CONTROLLER™......................................................................................118
P3-200 SYSTEM CONTROLLER™......................................................................................120
P3-PC SYSTEM CONTROLLER™........................................................................................122
p3 powerport 1500™........................................................................................................116
RAINMAC™..............................................................................................................................245
SAFETY WIRE...........................................................................................................................244
STAGEBAR 2™............................................................................................................................52
TOOLS.........................................................................................................................................248
TRIPIX 300™ AND 1200™.......................................................................................................62
TRIPIX WASH™..........................................................................................................................68
vc-dot 1™................................................................................................................................107
vc-dot 4™................................................................................................................................110
vc-dot 9™................................................................................................................................112
vc-feeder™............................................................................................................................111
vc-grid 25™...........................................................................................................................104
© 2012 Martin Professional A/S. Information subject to change without
notice. Martin Professional A/S and all affiliated companies disclaim liability
for any injury, damage, direct or indirect loss, consequential or economic loss
or any other loss occasioned by the use of, inability to use or reliance on the
information contained in this document. The Martin logo, the Martin name and
all other trademarks in this document pertaining to services or products by
Martin Professional A/S or its affiliates and subsidiaries are trademarks owned
or licensed by Martin Professional A/S or its affiliates or subsidiaries.
notes
All specifications and product designs are subject to change at any time and without notice.
© 2012 Martin Professional A/S.
Martin Professional A/S • Olof Palmes Allé 18 • 8200 Aarhus N • Denmark
Phone: +45 87 40 00 00 • Fax: + 45 87 40 00 10 • Internet: www.martin.com

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement